gdb: Respect field width and alignment for 'fmt' fields in CLI output
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "ui-out.h"
48 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
49 #include "block.h"
50 #include "solib.h"
51 #include "solist.h"
52 #include "observable.h"
53 #include "memattr.h"
54 #include "ada-lang.h"
55 #include "top.h"
56 #include "valprint.h"
57 #include "jit.h"
58 #include "parser-defs.h"
59 #include "gdb_regex.h"
60 #include "probe.h"
61 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
62 #include "continuations.h"
63 #include "stack.h"
64 #include "skip.h"
65 #include "ax-gdb.h"
66 #include "dummy-frame.h"
67 #include "interps.h"
68 #include "format.h"
69 #include "thread-fsm.h"
70 #include "tid-parse.h"
71
72 /* readline include files */
73 #include "readline/readline.h"
74 #include "readline/history.h"
75
76 /* readline defines this. */
77 #undef savestring
78
79 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
80 #include "extension.h"
81 #include <algorithm>
82 #include "progspace-and-thread.h"
83 #include "common/array-view.h"
84 #include "common/gdb_optional.h"
85
86 /* Enums for exception-handling support. */
87 enum exception_event_kind
88 {
89 EX_EVENT_THROW,
90 EX_EVENT_RETHROW,
91 EX_EVENT_CATCH
92 };
93
94 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
95
96 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
97 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>);
98
99 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
100
101 static void
102 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
103 struct linespec_result *canonical,
104 enum bptype type_wanted);
105
106 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
107 struct linespec_result *,
108 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
109 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
110 enum bptype,
111 enum bpdisp, int, int,
112 int,
113 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
114 int, int, int, unsigned);
115
116 static std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_default
117 (struct breakpoint *b, const struct event_location *location,
118 struct program_space *search_pspace);
119
120 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint
121 (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals);
122
123 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
124
125 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
126 enum bptype,
127 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
128 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
129 const struct symtab_and_line *);
130
131 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
132 static. */
133 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
134 struct symtab_and_line,
135 enum bptype,
136 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
137
138 static struct breakpoint *
139 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
140 enum bptype type,
141 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
142 int loc_enabled);
143
144 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
145
146 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
147 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
148 enum bptype bptype);
149
150 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
151 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
152 struct obj_section *, int);
153
154 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
155 struct bp_location *loc2);
156
157 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
158 const struct address_space *aspace,
159 CORE_ADDR addr);
160
161 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
162 const address_space *,
163 CORE_ADDR, int);
164
165 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
166 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
167
168 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
169
170 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
171
172 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
173
174 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
175 enum bptype type,
176 int *other_type_used);
177
178 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
179 int count);
180
181 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
182 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
183 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
184
185 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
186
187 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
188 insert locations now. */
189 enum ugll_insert_mode
190 {
191 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
192 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
193 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
194 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
195 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
196 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
197 returns true on them.
198
199 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
200 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
201 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
202 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
203 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
204 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
205 the inferior. */
206 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
207
208 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
209 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
210 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
211
212 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
213 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
214 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
215 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
216 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
217 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
218 as no thread is running yet. */
219 UGLL_INSERT
220 };
221
222 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
223
224 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
225
226 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
227
228 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
229
230 static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int);
231
232 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
233
234 static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
235
236 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
237
238 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
239 otherwise. */
240
241 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
242
243 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
244 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
245 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
246 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
247
248 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
249 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
250
251 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
252 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
253
254 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
255 breakpoints. */
256 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
257
258 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
259 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
260
261 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
262 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
263
264 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
265 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
266 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
267 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
268 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
269 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
270
271 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
272 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
273 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
274 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
275 dprintf_style_gdb,
276 dprintf_style_call,
277 dprintf_style_agent,
278 NULL
279 };
280 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
281
282 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
283 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
284 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
285 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
286
287 static char *dprintf_function;
288
289 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
290 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
291 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
292 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
293 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
294 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
295 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
296
297 static char *dprintf_channel;
298
299 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
300 has disconnected. */
301 static int disconnected_dprintf = 1;
302
303 struct command_line *
304 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
305 {
306 return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
307 }
308
309 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
310 current breakpoint. */
311
312 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
313
314 const char *
315 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
316 {
317 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
318 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
319 a breakpoint. */
320 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
321
322 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
323 }
324
325 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
326 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
327 if such is available. */
328 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
329
330 static void
331 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
332 struct cmd_list_element *c,
333 const char *value)
334 {
335 fprintf_filtered (file,
336 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
337 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
338 value);
339 }
340
341 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
342 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
343 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
344 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
345 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
346 static void
347 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
348 struct cmd_list_element *c,
349 const char *value)
350 {
351 fprintf_filtered (file,
352 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
353 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
354 value);
355 }
356
357 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
358 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
359 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
360 use hardware breakpoints. */
361 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
362 static void
363 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
364 struct cmd_list_element *c,
365 const char *value)
366 {
367 fprintf_filtered (file,
368 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
369 value);
370 }
371
372 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
373 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
374 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
375 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
376 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
377 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
378 processing user input. */
379 static int always_inserted_mode = 0;
380
381 static void
382 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
383 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
384 {
385 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
386 value);
387 }
388
389 /* See breakpoint.h. */
390
391 int
392 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
393 {
394 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
395 {
396 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
397 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
398 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
399 return 1;
400 }
401 else if (target_has_execution)
402 {
403 struct thread_info *tp;
404
405 if (always_inserted_mode)
406 {
407 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
408 are stopped. */
409 return 1;
410 }
411
412 if (threads_are_executing ())
413 return 1;
414
415 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
416 stopped, we still have events to process. */
417 ALL_NON_EXITED_THREADS (tp)
418 if (tp->resumed
419 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
420 return 1;
421 }
422 return 0;
423 }
424
425 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
426
427 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
428 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
429 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
430 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
431 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
432 condition_evaluation_auto,
433 condition_evaluation_host,
434 condition_evaluation_target,
435 NULL
436 };
437
438 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
439 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
440
441 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
442 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
443 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
444
445 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
446 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
447 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
448 evaluation mode. */
449
450 static const char *
451 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
452 {
453 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
454 {
455 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
456 return condition_evaluation_target;
457 else
458 return condition_evaluation_host;
459 }
460 else
461 return mode;
462 }
463
464 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
465
466 static const char *
467 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
468 {
469 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
470 }
471
472 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
473 otherwise. */
474
475 static int
476 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
477 {
478 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
479
480 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
481 }
482
483 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
484 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
485
486 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
487 static int overlay_events_enabled;
488
489 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
490 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
491
492 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
493 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
494 current breakpoint. */
495
496 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
497
498 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
499 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
500 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
501 B = TMP)
502
503 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
504 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
505 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
506
507 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
508 for (BP_TMP = bp_locations; \
509 BP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count && (B = *BP_TMP);\
510 BP_TMP++)
511
512 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
513 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
514 to where the loop should start from.
515 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
516 appropriate location to start with. */
517
518 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
519 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
520 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
521 BP_LOCP_START \
522 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count \
523 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
524 BP_LOCP_TMP++)
525
526 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
527
528 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
529 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
530 if (is_tracepoint (B))
531
532 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
533
534 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
535
536 /* Array is sorted by bp_locations_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
537
538 static struct bp_location **bp_locations;
539
540 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATIONS. */
541
542 static unsigned bp_locations_count;
543
544 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
545 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid
546 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
547 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for
548 an address you need to read. */
549
550 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max;
551
552 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
553 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
554 BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
555 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to
556 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
557
558 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max;
559
560 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
561 from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be
562 reported by a target. */
563 static std::vector<bp_location *> moribund_locations;
564
565 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
566
567 static int breakpoint_count;
568
569 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
570 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
571 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
572 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
573 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
574
575 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
576
577 static int tracepoint_count;
578
579 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
580 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
581 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
582
583 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
584
585 struct breakpoint *
586 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
587 void *user_data)
588 {
589 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
590
591 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
592 {
593 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
594 break;
595 }
596
597 return b;
598 }
599
600 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
601 static int
602 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
603 {
604 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
605 }
606
607 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
608
609 static void
610 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
611 {
612 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
613 breakpoint_count = num;
614 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
615 }
616
617 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
618 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
619 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
620
621 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
622 breakpoint made. */
623
624 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
625 {
626 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
627 }
628
629 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
630 breakpoint made. */
631
632 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
633 {
634 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
635 }
636
637 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
638
639 void
640 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
641 {
642 struct breakpoint *b;
643
644 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
645 b->hit_count = 0;
646 }
647
648 \f
649 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
650 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
651
652 struct breakpoint *
653 get_breakpoint (int num)
654 {
655 struct breakpoint *b;
656
657 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
658 if (b->number == num)
659 return b;
660
661 return NULL;
662 }
663
664 \f
665
666 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
667 evaluating conditions on its side. */
668
669 static void
670 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
671 {
672 struct bp_location *loc;
673
674 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
675 evaluating conditions and if the user has
676 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
677 side. */
678 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
679 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
680 return;
681
682 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
683 return;
684
685 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
686 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
687 }
688
689 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
690 evaluating conditions on its side. */
691
692 static void
693 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
694 {
695 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
696 evaluating conditions and if the user has
697 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
698 side. */
699 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
700 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
701
702 return;
703
704 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
705 return;
706
707 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
708 }
709
710 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
711 condition_evaluation_mode. */
712
713 static void
714 set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty,
715 struct cmd_list_element *c)
716 {
717 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
718
719 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
720 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
721 {
722 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
723 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
724 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
725 return;
726 }
727
728 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
729 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
730
731 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
732 settings was "auto". */
733 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
734
735 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
736 if (new_mode != old_mode)
737 {
738 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
739 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
740 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
741
742 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
743 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
744 */
745
746 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
747 {
748 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
749 target. */
750 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
751 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
752 }
753 else
754 {
755 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
756 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
757 target knows about. */
758 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
759 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
760 loc->needs_update = 1;
761 }
762
763 /* Do the update. */
764 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
765 }
766
767 return;
768 }
769
770 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
771 what "auto" is translating to. */
772
773 static void
774 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
775 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
776 {
777 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
778 fprintf_filtered (file,
779 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
780 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
781 value,
782 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
783 else
784 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
785 value);
786 }
787
788 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
789 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
790 the more general bp_locations_compare function. */
791
792 static int
793 bp_locations_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
794 {
795 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
796 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
797
798 if (a->address == b->address)
799 return 0;
800 else
801 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
802 }
803
804 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
805 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
806 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
807 return NULL. */
808
809 static struct bp_location **
810 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
811 {
812 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
813 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
814 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
815
816 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
817 dummy_loc.address = address;
818
819 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
820 locp_found = ((struct bp_location **)
821 bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_locations, bp_locations_count,
822 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
823 bp_locations_compare_addrs));
824
825 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
826 if (locp_found == NULL)
827 return NULL;
828
829 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
830 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
831 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_locations
832 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
833 locp_found--;
834
835 return locp_found;
836 }
837
838 void
839 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
840 int from_tty)
841 {
842 xfree (b->cond_string);
843 b->cond_string = NULL;
844
845 if (is_watchpoint (b))
846 {
847 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
848
849 w->cond_exp.reset ();
850 }
851 else
852 {
853 struct bp_location *loc;
854
855 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
856 {
857 loc->cond.reset ();
858
859 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
860 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
861 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
862 }
863 }
864
865 if (*exp == 0)
866 {
867 if (from_tty)
868 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
869 }
870 else
871 {
872 const char *arg = exp;
873
874 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
875 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
876 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
877 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
878
879 if (is_watchpoint (b))
880 {
881 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
882
883 innermost_block.reset ();
884 arg = exp;
885 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
886 if (*arg)
887 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
888 w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
889 }
890 else
891 {
892 struct bp_location *loc;
893
894 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
895 {
896 arg = exp;
897 loc->cond =
898 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
899 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
900 if (*arg)
901 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
902 }
903 }
904 }
905 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
906
907 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
908 }
909
910 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
911
912 static void
913 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
914 completion_tracker &tracker,
915 const char *text, const char *word)
916 {
917 const char *space;
918
919 text = skip_spaces (text);
920 space = skip_to_space (text);
921 if (*space == '\0')
922 {
923 int len;
924 struct breakpoint *b;
925
926 if (text[0] == '$')
927 {
928 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
929 if (!isdigit (text[1]))
930 complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]);
931 return;
932 }
933
934 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
935 len = strlen (text);
936
937 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
938 {
939 char number[50];
940
941 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
942
943 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
944 {
945 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> copy (xstrdup (number));
946 tracker.add_completion (std::move (copy));
947 }
948 }
949
950 return;
951 }
952
953 /* We're completing the expression part. */
954 text = skip_spaces (space);
955 expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word);
956 }
957
958 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
959
960 static void
961 condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
962 {
963 struct breakpoint *b;
964 const char *p;
965 int bnum;
966
967 if (arg == 0)
968 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
969
970 p = arg;
971 bnum = get_number (&p);
972 if (bnum == 0)
973 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
974
975 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
976 if (b->number == bnum)
977 {
978 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
979 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
980 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
981 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
982 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
983
984 if (extlang != NULL)
985 {
986 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
987 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
988 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
989 }
990 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
991
992 if (is_breakpoint (b))
993 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
994
995 return;
996 }
997
998 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
999 }
1000
1001 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1002 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1003 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1004
1005 static void
1006 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1007 {
1008 struct command_line *c;
1009
1010 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1011 {
1012 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1013 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1014 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1015
1016 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_0.get ());
1017 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_1.get ());
1018
1019 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1020 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1021 command directly. */
1022 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1023 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1024
1025 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1026 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1027 }
1028 }
1029
1030 struct longjmp_breakpoint : public breakpoint
1031 {
1032 ~longjmp_breakpoint () override;
1033 };
1034
1035 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1036
1037 static bool
1038 is_tracepoint_type (bptype type)
1039 {
1040 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1041 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1042 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1043 }
1044
1045 static bool
1046 is_longjmp_type (bptype type)
1047 {
1048 return type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception;
1049 }
1050
1051 int
1052 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1053 {
1054 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1055 }
1056
1057 /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given
1058 TYPE. */
1059
1060 static std::unique_ptr<breakpoint>
1061 new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype type)
1062 {
1063 breakpoint *b;
1064
1065 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
1066 b = new tracepoint ();
1067 else if (is_longjmp_type (type))
1068 b = new longjmp_breakpoint ();
1069 else
1070 b = new breakpoint ();
1071
1072 return std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> (b);
1073 }
1074
1075 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1076 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1077 found. */
1078
1079 static void
1080 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1081 struct command_line *commands)
1082 {
1083 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1084 {
1085 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1086 struct command_line *c;
1087 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1088
1089 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1090 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1091 ones might not. */
1092 t->step_count = 0;
1093
1094 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1095 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1096 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1097 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1098 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1099 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1100 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1101 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1102 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1103 tracepoint's context. */
1104 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1105 {
1106 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1107 {
1108 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1109 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1110 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1111 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1112 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1113 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1114
1115 if (while_stepping)
1116 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1117 "can be used only once"));
1118 else
1119 while_stepping = c;
1120 }
1121
1122 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1123 }
1124 if (while_stepping)
1125 {
1126 struct command_line *c2;
1127
1128 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_list_1 == nullptr);
1129 c2 = while_stepping->body_list_0.get ();
1130 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1131 {
1132 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1133 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1134 }
1135 }
1136 }
1137 else
1138 {
1139 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1140 }
1141 }
1142
1143 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1144 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1145
1146 std::vector<breakpoint *>
1147 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1148 {
1149 struct breakpoint *b;
1150 std::vector<breakpoint *> found;
1151 struct bp_location *loc;
1152
1153 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1154 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1155 {
1156 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1157 if (loc->address == addr)
1158 found.push_back (b);
1159 }
1160
1161 return found;
1162 }
1163
1164 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1165 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1166
1167 void
1168 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1169 counted_command_line &&commands)
1170 {
1171 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ());
1172
1173 b->commands = std::move (commands);
1174 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1175 }
1176
1177 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1178 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1179 commands. */
1180
1181 void
1182 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1183 {
1184 int old_silent = b->silent;
1185
1186 b->silent = silent;
1187 if (old_silent != silent)
1188 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1189 }
1190
1191 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1192 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1193
1194 void
1195 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1196 {
1197 int old_thread = b->thread;
1198
1199 b->thread = thread;
1200 if (old_thread != thread)
1201 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1202 }
1203
1204 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1205 breakpoint work for any task. */
1206
1207 void
1208 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1209 {
1210 int old_task = b->task;
1211
1212 b->task = task;
1213 if (old_task != task)
1214 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1215 }
1216
1217 static void
1218 commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
1219 struct command_line *control)
1220 {
1221 counted_command_line cmd;
1222 /* cmd_read will be true once we have read cmd. Note that cmd might still be
1223 NULL after the call to read_command_lines if the user provides an empty
1224 list of command by just typing "end". */
1225 bool cmd_read = false;
1226
1227 std::string new_arg;
1228
1229 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1230 {
1231 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1232 new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1233 breakpoint_count);
1234 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1235 new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1236 arg = new_arg.c_str ();
1237 }
1238
1239 map_breakpoint_numbers
1240 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
1241 {
1242 if (!cmd_read)
1243 {
1244 gdb_assert (cmd == NULL);
1245 if (control != NULL)
1246 cmd = control->body_list_0;
1247 else
1248 {
1249 std::string str
1250 = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1251 "%s, one per line."),
1252 arg);
1253
1254 auto do_validate = [=] (const char *line)
1255 {
1256 validate_actionline (line, b);
1257 };
1258 gdb::function_view<void (const char *)> validator;
1259 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1260 validator = do_validate;
1261
1262 cmd = read_command_lines (str.c_str (), from_tty, 1, validator);
1263 }
1264 cmd_read = true;
1265 }
1266
1267 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1268 do anything. */
1269 if (b->commands != cmd)
1270 {
1271 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ());
1272 b->commands = cmd;
1273 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1274 }
1275 });
1276 }
1277
1278 static void
1279 commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
1280 {
1281 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1282 }
1283
1284 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1285 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1286
1287 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1288 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1289 enum command_control_type
1290 commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1291 {
1292 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1293 return simple_control;
1294 }
1295
1296 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1297
1298 static int
1299 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1300 {
1301 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1302 return 0;
1303 if (!bl->inserted)
1304 return 0;
1305 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1306 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1307 return 0;
1308 return 1;
1309 }
1310
1311 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1312 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1313 contents.
1314
1315 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1316 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1317 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1318
1319 static void
1320 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1321 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1322 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1323 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1324 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1325 {
1326 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1327 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1328 int bp_size = 0;
1329 int bptoffset = 0;
1330
1331 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1332 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1333 {
1334 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1335 return;
1336 }
1337
1338 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1339 we need to copy. */
1340 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1341 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1342
1343 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1344 {
1345 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1346 reading. */
1347 return;
1348 }
1349
1350 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1351 {
1352 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1353 reading. */
1354 return;
1355 }
1356
1357 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1358 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1359 {
1360 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1361 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1362 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1363 bp_addr = memaddr;
1364 }
1365
1366 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1367 {
1368 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1369 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1370 }
1371
1372 if (readbuf != NULL)
1373 {
1374 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1375 shadow_contents buffer. */
1376 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1377 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1378 + target_info->shadow_len));
1379
1380 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1381 shadow. */
1382 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1383 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1384 }
1385 else
1386 {
1387 const unsigned char *bp;
1388 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1389 int placed_size;
1390
1391 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1392 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1393 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1394
1395 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1396 address. */
1397 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1398
1399 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1400 breakpoint's INSN. */
1401 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1402 }
1403 }
1404
1405 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1406 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1407
1408 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1409 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1410 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1411
1412 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1413 bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1414 up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1415 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1416 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1417 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1418 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1419 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
1420 and:
1421 bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1422
1423 void
1424 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1425 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1426 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1427 {
1428 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1429 search. */
1430 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1431
1432 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1433 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1434 report higher one. */
1435
1436 bc_l = 0;
1437 bc_r = bp_locations_count;
1438 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1439 {
1440 struct bp_location *bl;
1441
1442 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1443 bl = bp_locations[bc];
1444
1445 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1446 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1447 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1448 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1449
1450 Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1451 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1452 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1453
1454 if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1455 >= bl->address)
1456 && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1457 <= memaddr))
1458 bc_l = bc;
1459 else
1460 bc_r = bc;
1461 }
1462
1463 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1464 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1465 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1466 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1467 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1468 B:
1469
1470 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1471
1472 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1473 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1474 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1475 and L2. */
1476 while (bc_l > 0
1477 && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address)
1478 bc_l--;
1479
1480 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1481
1482 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations_count; bc++)
1483 {
1484 struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc];
1485
1486 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1487 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1488 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1489 bl->owner->number);
1490
1491 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1492 content. */
1493
1494 if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1495 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1496 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max))
1497 break;
1498
1499 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1500 continue;
1501
1502 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1503 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1504 }
1505 }
1506
1507 \f
1508
1509 /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1510 breakpoint. */
1511
1512 int
1513 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1514 {
1515 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1516 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1517 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1518 }
1519
1520 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1521
1522 static int
1523 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1524 {
1525 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1526 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1527 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1528 }
1529
1530 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1531 software. */
1532
1533 int
1534 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1535 {
1536 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1537 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1538 }
1539
1540 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1541 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1542 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1543 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1544 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1545 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1546 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1547 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1548
1549 static int
1550 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1551 {
1552 return (b->pspace == current_program_space
1553 && (b->watchpoint_thread == null_ptid
1554 || (inferior_ptid == b->watchpoint_thread
1555 && !inferior_thread ()->executing)));
1556 }
1557
1558 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1559 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1560
1561 static void
1562 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1563 {
1564 if (w->related_breakpoint != w)
1565 {
1566 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1567 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w);
1568 w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1569 w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint;
1570 w->related_breakpoint = w;
1571 }
1572 w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1573 }
1574
1575 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1576 watchpoint W. */
1577
1578 static struct value *
1579 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1580 {
1581 struct value *bit_val;
1582
1583 if (val == NULL)
1584 return NULL;
1585
1586 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1587
1588 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1589 w->val_bitpos,
1590 w->val_bitsize,
1591 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1592 value_offset (val),
1593 val);
1594
1595 return bit_val;
1596 }
1597
1598 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1599 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1600 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1601 to be able to report stops. */
1602
1603 static void
1604 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
1605 struct program_space *pspace)
1606 {
1607 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
1608
1609 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1610 b->loc->pspace = pspace;
1611 b->loc->address = -1;
1612 b->loc->length = -1;
1613 }
1614
1615 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1616 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1617
1618 static int
1619 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
1620 {
1621 return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
1622 && b->loc != NULL
1623 && b->loc->next == NULL
1624 && b->loc->address == -1
1625 && b->loc->length == -1);
1626 }
1627
1628 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1629 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1630 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1631 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1632 in b->loc->cond.
1633 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1634
1635 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1636 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1637 it.
1638
1639 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1640 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1641 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1642 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1643 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1644 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1645 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1646 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1647
1648 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1649 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1650 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1651 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1652 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1653 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1654 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1655 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1656 not changed.
1657
1658 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1659 hardware watchpoints:
1660
1661 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1662 called several times when GDB stops.
1663
1664 [linux]
1665 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1666 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1667 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1668 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1669 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1670 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1671 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1672 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1673 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1674 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1675 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1676
1677 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1678 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1679
1680 static void
1681 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1682 {
1683 int within_current_scope;
1684 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1685 int frame_saved;
1686
1687 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1688 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1689 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1690 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1691 return;
1692
1693 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1694 return;
1695
1696 frame_saved = 0;
1697
1698 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1699 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1700 within_current_scope = 1;
1701 else
1702 {
1703 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1704 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1705 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1706
1707 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1708 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1709 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1710 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1711 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1712 return;
1713
1714 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1715 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1716 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1717 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1718 selected frame. */
1719 frame_saved = 1;
1720 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1721
1722 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1723 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1724 if (within_current_scope)
1725 select_frame (fi);
1726 }
1727
1728 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1729 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1730 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1731 b->loc = NULL;
1732
1733 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1734 {
1735 const char *s;
1736
1737 b->exp.reset ();
1738 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1739 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1740 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1741 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1742 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1743 be completely different objects. */
1744 b->val = NULL;
1745 b->val_valid = 0;
1746
1747 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1748 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1749 locations (re)created below. */
1750 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1751 {
1752 b->cond_exp.reset ();
1753
1754 s = b->cond_string;
1755 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1756 }
1757 }
1758
1759 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1760 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1761 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1762 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1763 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1764 if (!target_has_execution)
1765 {
1766 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1767 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1768 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1769 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1770 {
1771 if (b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1772 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1773 else
1774 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1775 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1776 }
1777 }
1778 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1779 {
1780 int pc = 0;
1781 std::vector<value_ref_ptr> val_chain;
1782 struct value *v, *result;
1783 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1784
1785 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1786
1787 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1788 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1789 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1790 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1791 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1792 watchpoints. */
1793 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b))
1794 {
1795 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1796 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1797 b->val = release_value (v);
1798 b->val_valid = 1;
1799 }
1800
1801 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1802
1803 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1804 gdb_assert (!val_chain.empty ());
1805 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : val_chain)
1806 {
1807 v = iter.get ();
1808
1809 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1810 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1811 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1812 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1813 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1814 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1815 && (v == val_chain[0] || ! value_lazy (v)))
1816 {
1817 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1818
1819 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1820 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1821 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1822 if (v == result
1823 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1824 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1825 {
1826 CORE_ADDR addr;
1827 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1828 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1829 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1830
1831 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1832 {
1833 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1834 sub-expression. */
1835 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1836 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1837 }
1838 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1839 {
1840 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1841 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1842 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1843 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1844 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
1845 }
1846
1847 addr = value_address (v);
1848 if (bitsize != 0)
1849 {
1850 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
1851 addr += bitpos / 8;
1852 }
1853
1854 type = hw_write;
1855 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1856 type = hw_read;
1857 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1858 type = hw_access;
1859
1860 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1861 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1862 ;
1863 *tmp = loc;
1864 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1865
1866 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1867 loc->address = address_significant (loc->gdbarch, addr);
1868
1869 if (bitsize != 0)
1870 {
1871 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
1872 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
1873 }
1874 else
1875 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1876
1877 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1878 }
1879 }
1880 }
1881
1882 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1883 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1884 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1885 is started. */
1886 if (reparse)
1887 {
1888 int reg_cnt;
1889 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
1890 struct bp_location *bl;
1891
1892 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1893
1894 if (reg_cnt)
1895 {
1896 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
1897 enum bptype type;
1898
1899 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
1900 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
1901 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
1902
1903 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
1904 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
1905 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
1906 this watchpoint in as well. */
1907
1908 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
1909 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
1910 hardware watchpoint type. */
1911 type = b->type;
1912 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
1913 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1914
1915 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
1916 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
1917 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
1918 through watch_command), so always account for it
1919 manually. */
1920
1921 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
1922 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used);
1923
1924 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
1925 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
1926
1927 target_resources_ok
1928 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
1929 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1930 {
1931 int sw_mode = b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b);
1932
1933 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
1934 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
1935 "hardware watchpoint."));
1936 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
1937 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
1938 "resources for this watchpoint."));
1939
1940 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
1941 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1942 }
1943 else
1944 {
1945 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
1946 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
1947 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
1948 nop. */
1949 b->type = type;
1950 }
1951 }
1952 else if (!b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1953 {
1954 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1955 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1956 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1957 else
1958 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
1959 "read/access watchpoint."));
1960 }
1961 else
1962 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1963
1964 loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
1965 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
1966 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
1967 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
1968 }
1969
1970 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1971 above left it without any location set up. But,
1972 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1973 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1974 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
1975 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (b, frame_pspace);
1976 }
1977 else if (!within_current_scope)
1978 {
1979 printf_filtered (_("\
1980 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
1981 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1982 b->number);
1983 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
1984 }
1985
1986 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1987 if (frame_saved)
1988 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1989 }
1990
1991
1992 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1993 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
1994 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
1995 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
1996 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
1997 static int
1998 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
1999 {
2000 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2001 return 0;
2002
2003 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2004 return 0;
2005
2006 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2007 return 0;
2008
2009 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2010 return 0;
2011
2012 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2013 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2014 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2015 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2016 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2017 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2018 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2019 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2020 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2021 return 0;
2022
2023 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2024 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2025 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2026 a breakpoint. */
2027 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2028 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2029 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2030 bl->address)
2031 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2032 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2033 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2034 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2035 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2036 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2037 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2038 && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
2039 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
2040 {
2041 if (debug_infrun)
2042 {
2043 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2044 "infrun: skipping breakpoint: "
2045 "stepping past insn at: %s\n",
2046 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2047 }
2048 return 0;
2049 }
2050
2051 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2052 instruction that triggered one. */
2053 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2054 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2055 {
2056 if (debug_infrun)
2057 {
2058 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2059 "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2060 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2061 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2062 bl->length);
2063 }
2064 return 0;
2065 }
2066
2067 return 1;
2068 }
2069
2070 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2071 that the location is not duplicated. */
2072
2073 static int
2074 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2075 {
2076 int result;
2077 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2078
2079 bl->duplicate = 0;
2080 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2081 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2082 return result;
2083 }
2084
2085 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2086 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2087 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2088 any error during parsing. */
2089
2090 static agent_expr_up
2091 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2092 {
2093 if (cond == NULL)
2094 return NULL;
2095
2096 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2097
2098 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2099 that may show up. */
2100 TRY
2101 {
2102 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2103 }
2104
2105 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2106 {
2107 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2108 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2109 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2110 }
2111 END_CATCH
2112
2113 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2114 return aexpr;
2115 }
2116
2117 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2118 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2119 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2120 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2121 one of them is true. */
2122
2123 static void
2124 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2125 {
2126 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2127 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2128 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2129 struct bp_location *loc;
2130
2131 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2132 bl->target_info.conditions.clear ();
2133
2134 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2135 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2136 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2137 side. */
2138 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2139 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2140 return;
2141
2142 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2143 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2144 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2145 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2146 response back to GDB. */
2147 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2148 {
2149 loc = (*loc2p);
2150 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2151 {
2152 if (modified)
2153 {
2154 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2155 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2156 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2157 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2158 loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2159 loc->cond.get ());
2160 }
2161
2162 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2163 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2164 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2165 {
2166 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2167 break;
2168 }
2169 }
2170 }
2171
2172 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2173 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2174 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2175
2176 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2177 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2178 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2179 {
2180 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2181 {
2182 loc = (*loc2p);
2183 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2184 {
2185 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2186 located. */
2187 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2188 return;
2189
2190 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
2191 }
2192 }
2193 }
2194
2195 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2196 for this location's address. */
2197 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2198 {
2199 loc = (*loc2p);
2200 if (loc->cond
2201 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2202 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2203 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2204 && loc->enabled)
2205 {
2206 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
2207 to send the conditions to the target. */
2208 bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ());
2209 }
2210 }
2211
2212 return;
2213 }
2214
2215 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2216 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2217 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2218
2219 static agent_expr_up
2220 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2221 {
2222 const char *cmdrest;
2223 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2224 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2225
2226 if (cmd == NULL)
2227 return NULL;
2228
2229 cmdrest = cmd;
2230
2231 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2232 ++cmdrest;
2233 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2234
2235 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2236 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2237
2238 format_start = cmdrest;
2239
2240 format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest);
2241
2242 format_end = cmdrest;
2243
2244 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2245 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2246
2247 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2248
2249 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2250 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2251
2252 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2253 cmdrest++;
2254 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2255
2256 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2257
2258 std::vector<struct expression *> argvec;
2259 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2260 {
2261 const char *cmd1;
2262
2263 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2264 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2265 argvec.push_back (expr.release ());
2266 cmdrest = cmd1;
2267 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2268 ++cmdrest;
2269 }
2270
2271 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2272
2273 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2274 that may show up. */
2275 TRY
2276 {
2277 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2278 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2279 argvec.size (), argvec.data ());
2280 }
2281 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2282 {
2283 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2284 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2285 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2286 }
2287 END_CATCH
2288
2289 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2290 return aexpr;
2291 }
2292
2293 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2294 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2295 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2296
2297 static void
2298 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2299 {
2300 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2301 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2302 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2303 struct bp_location *loc;
2304
2305 /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
2306 bl->target_info.tcommands.clear ();
2307
2308 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2309 return;
2310
2311 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2312 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2313 return;
2314
2315 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2316 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2317 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2318 control. */
2319 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2320 {
2321 loc = (*loc2p);
2322 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2323 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2324 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2325 return;
2326 }
2327
2328 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2329 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2330 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2331 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2332 response back to GDB. */
2333 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2334 {
2335 loc = (*loc2p);
2336 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2337 {
2338 if (modified)
2339 {
2340 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2341 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2342 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2343 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2344 loc->cmd_bytecode
2345 = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2346 loc->owner->extra_string);
2347 }
2348
2349 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2350 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2351 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2352 {
2353 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2354 break;
2355 }
2356 }
2357 }
2358
2359 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2360 and so clean up. */
2361 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2362 {
2363 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2364 {
2365 loc = (*loc2p);
2366 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2367 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2368 {
2369 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2370 located. */
2371 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2372 return;
2373
2374 loc->cmd_bytecode.reset ();
2375 }
2376 }
2377 }
2378
2379 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2380 for this location's address. */
2381 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2382 {
2383 loc = (*loc2p);
2384 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2385 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2386 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2387 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2388 && loc->enabled)
2389 {
2390 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2391 to send the commands to the target. */
2392 bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ());
2393 }
2394 }
2395
2396 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2397 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2398 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2399 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2400 }
2401
2402 /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
2403 of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
2404 Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
2405 registers state. */
2406
2407 static int
2408 breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr)
2409 {
2410 if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step)
2411 {
2412 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread);
2413 struct regcache *regcache;
2414
2415 regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr);
2416
2417 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch,
2418 regcache, addr);
2419 }
2420 else
2421 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr);
2422 }
2423
2424 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2425 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2426 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2427 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2428 -1 for failure.
2429
2430 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2431 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2432 static int
2433 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2434 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2435 int *disabled_breaks,
2436 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2437 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2438 {
2439 gdb_exception bp_excpt = exception_none;
2440
2441 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2442 return 0;
2443
2444 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2445 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2446 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2447 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2448 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2449 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2450 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2451 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2452 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2453 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2454 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2455 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2456
2457 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2458 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2459 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2460 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2461
2462 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2463 {
2464 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2465 build_target_command_list (bl);
2466 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2467 bl->needs_update = 0;
2468 }
2469
2470 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2471 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2472 {
2473 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2474 {
2475 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2476 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2477 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2478
2479 Two important cases are:
2480 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2481 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2482 hardware breakpoint.
2483 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2484 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2485 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2486 so we undo.
2487
2488 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2489 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2490 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2491 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2492 gdb. */
2493 struct mem_region *mr
2494 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address);
2495
2496 if (mr)
2497 {
2498 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2499 {
2500 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2501
2502 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2503 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2504 else
2505 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2506
2507 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2508 {
2509 static int said = 0;
2510
2511 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2512 if (!said)
2513 {
2514 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2515 _("Note: automatically using "
2516 "hardware breakpoints for "
2517 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2518 said = 1;
2519 }
2520 }
2521 }
2522 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2523 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2524 {
2525 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2526 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2527 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2528 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2529 bl->owner->number,
2530 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2531 return 1;
2532 }
2533 }
2534 }
2535
2536 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2537 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2538 || bl->section == NULL
2539 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2540 {
2541 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2542 TRY
2543 {
2544 int val;
2545
2546 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2547 if (val)
2548 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2549 }
2550 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2551 {
2552 bp_excpt = e;
2553 }
2554 END_CATCH
2555 }
2556 else
2557 {
2558 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2559 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2560 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2561 {
2562 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2563 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2564 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2565 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2566 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2567 bl->owner->number);
2568 else
2569 {
2570 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2571 bl->section);
2572 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2573 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2574 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2575
2576 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2577 TRY
2578 {
2579 int val;
2580
2581 bl->overlay_target_info.kind
2582 = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
2583 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2584 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2585 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2586 if (val)
2587 bp_excpt
2588 = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2589 }
2590 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2591 {
2592 bp_excpt = e;
2593 }
2594 END_CATCH
2595
2596 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2597 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2598 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2599 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2600 bl->owner->number);
2601 }
2602 }
2603 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2604 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2605 {
2606 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2607 TRY
2608 {
2609 int val;
2610
2611 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2612 if (val)
2613 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2614 }
2615 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2616 {
2617 bp_excpt = e;
2618 }
2619 END_CATCH
2620 }
2621 else
2622 {
2623 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2624 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2625 return 0;
2626 }
2627 }
2628
2629 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2630 {
2631 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2632
2633 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2634 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2635 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2636 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2637 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2638 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2639 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2640 errors as memory errors. */
2641 if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR
2642 && (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR
2643 || bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR)
2644 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2645 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2646 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2647 bl->address)))
2648 {
2649 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2650 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2651 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bl->owner);
2652 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2653 {
2654 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2655 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2656 bl->owner->number);
2657 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2658 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2659 "library breakpoints:\n");
2660 }
2661 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2662 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2663 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2664 return 0;
2665 }
2666 else
2667 {
2668 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2669 {
2670 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2671 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL;
2672 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2673 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2674 bl->owner->number,
2675 bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n");
2676 if (bp_excpt.message != NULL)
2677 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n",
2678 bp_excpt.message);
2679 }
2680 else
2681 {
2682 if (bp_excpt.message == NULL)
2683 {
2684 std::string message
2685 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2686 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2687
2688 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2689 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2690 "%s\n",
2691 bl->owner->number, message.c_str ());
2692 }
2693 else
2694 {
2695 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2696 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2697 bl->owner->number,
2698 bp_excpt.message);
2699 }
2700 }
2701 return 1;
2702
2703 }
2704 }
2705 else
2706 bl->inserted = 1;
2707
2708 return 0;
2709 }
2710
2711 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2712 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2713 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2714 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2715 {
2716 int val;
2717
2718 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2719 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2720
2721 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2722
2723 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2724 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2725 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2726 {
2727 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2728
2729 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2730 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2731 of this one. */
2732 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2733 if (loc != bl
2734 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2735 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2736 {
2737 bl->duplicate = 1;
2738 bl->inserted = 1;
2739 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2740 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2741 val = 0;
2742 break;
2743 }
2744
2745 if (val == 1)
2746 {
2747 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2748 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2749
2750 if (val)
2751 /* Back to the original value. */
2752 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2753 }
2754 }
2755
2756 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2757 }
2758
2759 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2760 {
2761 int val;
2762
2763 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2764 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2765
2766 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2767 if (val)
2768 {
2769 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2770
2771 if (val == 1)
2772 warning (_("\
2773 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2774 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2775 else
2776 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2777 }
2778
2779 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2780
2781 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2782 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2783 so just return success. */
2784 return 0;
2785 }
2786
2787 return 0;
2788 }
2789
2790 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2791 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2792 PSPACE anymore. */
2793
2794 void
2795 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2796 {
2797 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2798 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2799
2800 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2801 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2802 {
2803 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2804 delete_breakpoint (b);
2805 }
2806
2807 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2808 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2809 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2810 {
2811 struct bp_location *tmp;
2812
2813 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2814 {
2815 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2816 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2817 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2818 else
2819 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2820 if (tmp->next == loc)
2821 {
2822 tmp->next = loc->next;
2823 break;
2824 }
2825 }
2826 }
2827
2828 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2829 removed locations above. */
2830 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2831 }
2832
2833 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2834 Throws exception on any error.
2835 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2836 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2837 void
2838 insert_breakpoints (void)
2839 {
2840 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2841
2842 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2843 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2844 {
2845 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2846
2847 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2848 }
2849
2850 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
2851 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
2852 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. */
2853 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
2854 }
2855
2856 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
2857
2858 void
2859 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
2860 {
2861 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
2862
2863 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
2864 {
2865 callback (loc, NULL);
2866 }
2867 }
2868
2869 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2870 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2871 always-inserted mode. */
2872
2873 static void
2874 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2875 {
2876 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2877 int error_flag = 0;
2878 int val = 0;
2879 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2880 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2881 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
2882
2883 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2884
2885 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2886 there was an error. */
2887 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2888
2889 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2890
2891 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2892 {
2893 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2894 breakpoints. */
2895 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2896 continue;
2897
2898 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2899 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2900 deletion of breakpoints. */
2901 if (!bl->inserted || !bl->needs_update)
2902 continue;
2903
2904 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2905
2906 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2907 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2908 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2909 insert breakpoints. */
2910 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2911 && inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
2912 continue;
2913
2914 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2915 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
2916 if (val)
2917 error_flag = val;
2918 }
2919
2920 if (error_flag)
2921 {
2922 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
2923 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2924 }
2925 }
2926
2927 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2928
2929 static void
2930 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2931 {
2932 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2933 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2934 int error_flag = 0;
2935 int val = 0;
2936 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2937 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2938 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
2939
2940 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2941
2942 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2943 there was an error. */
2944 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2945
2946 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2947
2948 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2949 {
2950 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2951 continue;
2952
2953 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
2954 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
2955 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2956 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
2957 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
2958 continue;
2959
2960 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2961
2962 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2963 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2964 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2965 insert breakpoints. */
2966 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2967 && inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
2968 continue;
2969
2970 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2971 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
2972 if (val)
2973 error_flag = val;
2974 }
2975
2976 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
2977 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
2978 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2979 {
2980 int some_failed = 0;
2981 struct bp_location *loc;
2982
2983 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2984 continue;
2985
2986 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2987 continue;
2988
2989 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2990 continue;
2991
2992 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2993 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
2994 {
2995 some_failed = 1;
2996 break;
2997 }
2998 if (some_failed)
2999 {
3000 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3001 if (loc->inserted)
3002 remove_breakpoint (loc);
3003
3004 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3005 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert "
3006 "hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3007 bpt->number);
3008 error_flag = -1;
3009 }
3010 }
3011
3012 if (error_flag)
3013 {
3014 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3015 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3016 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3017 {
3018 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3019 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3020 }
3021 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
3022 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3023 }
3024 }
3025
3026 /* Used when the program stops.
3027 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3028 removing a breakpoint location. */
3029
3030 int
3031 remove_breakpoints (void)
3032 {
3033 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3034 int val = 0;
3035
3036 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3037 {
3038 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3039 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
3040 }
3041 return val;
3042 }
3043
3044 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3045 that thread. */
3046
3047 static void
3048 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3049 {
3050 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3051
3052 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3053 {
3054 if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3055 {
3056 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3057
3058 printf_filtered (_("\
3059 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3060 b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
3061
3062 /* Hide it from the user. */
3063 b->number = 0;
3064 }
3065 }
3066 }
3067
3068 /* Remove breakpoints of inferior INF. */
3069
3070 int
3071 remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior *inf)
3072 {
3073 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3074 int val;
3075
3076 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3077 {
3078 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3079 continue;
3080
3081 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3082 {
3083 val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
3084 if (val != 0)
3085 return val;
3086 }
3087 }
3088 return 0;
3089 }
3090
3091 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3092
3093 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3094 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3095 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3096 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3097 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3098 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3099 static void
3100 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3101 {
3102 if (internal)
3103 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3104 else
3105 {
3106 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3107 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3108 }
3109 }
3110
3111 static struct breakpoint *
3112 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3113 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3114 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3115 {
3116 symtab_and_line sal;
3117 sal.pc = address;
3118 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3119 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3120
3121 breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3122 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3123 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3124
3125 return b;
3126 }
3127
3128 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3129 {
3130 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3131 };
3132 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3133
3134 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3135 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3136 {
3137 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3138 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym {};
3139
3140 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3141 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES] {};
3142
3143 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3144 int longjmp_searched = 0;
3145
3146 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning
3147 references. */
3148 std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes;
3149
3150 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3151 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym {};
3152
3153 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3154 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym {};
3155
3156 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3157 int exception_searched = 0;
3158
3159 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning
3160 references. */
3161 std::vector<probe *> exception_probes;
3162 };
3163
3164 static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
3165
3166 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3167 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3168
3169 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3170
3171 static int
3172 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3173 {
3174 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3175 }
3176
3177 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3178 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3179
3180 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3181 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3182 {
3183 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3184
3185 bp_objfile_data = ((struct breakpoint_objfile_data *)
3186 objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key));
3187 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3188 {
3189 bp_objfile_data = new breakpoint_objfile_data ();
3190 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
3191 }
3192 return bp_objfile_data;
3193 }
3194
3195 static void
3196 free_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *obj, void *data)
3197 {
3198 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3199 = (struct breakpoint_objfile_data *) data;
3200
3201 delete bp_objfile_data;
3202 }
3203
3204 static void
3205 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3206 {
3207 struct objfile *objfile;
3208 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3209
3210 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3211 {
3212 struct breakpoint *b;
3213 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3214 CORE_ADDR addr;
3215 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3216
3217 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3218
3219 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3220 continue;
3221
3222 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3223 {
3224 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3225
3226 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3227 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3228 {
3229 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3230 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3231 continue;
3232 }
3233 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3234 }
3235
3236 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3237 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3238 bp_overlay_event,
3239 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3240 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3241 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3242 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3243
3244 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3245 {
3246 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3247 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3248 }
3249 else
3250 {
3251 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3252 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3253 }
3254 }
3255 }
3256
3257 static void
3258 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3259 {
3260 struct program_space *pspace;
3261
3262 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3263
3264 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3265 {
3266 struct objfile *objfile;
3267
3268 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3269
3270 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3271 {
3272 int i;
3273 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3274 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3275
3276 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3277
3278 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3279
3280 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3281 {
3282 std::vector<probe *> ret
3283 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3284
3285 if (!ret.empty ())
3286 {
3287 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3288 probe *p = ret[0];
3289
3290 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3291 {
3292 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3293 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3294 ret.clear ();
3295 }
3296 }
3297 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3298 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3299 }
3300
3301 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ())
3302 {
3303 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes)
3304 {
3305 struct breakpoint *b;
3306
3307 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3308 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3309 bp_longjmp_master,
3310 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3311 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3312 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3313 }
3314
3315 continue;
3316 }
3317
3318 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3319 continue;
3320
3321 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3322 {
3323 struct breakpoint *b;
3324 const char *func_name;
3325 CORE_ADDR addr;
3326 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3327
3328 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3329 continue;
3330
3331 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3332 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3333 {
3334 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3335
3336 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3337 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3338 {
3339 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3340 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3341 continue;
3342 }
3343 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3344 }
3345
3346 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3347 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3348 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3349 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3350 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3351 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3352 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3353 }
3354 }
3355 }
3356 }
3357
3358 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3359 static void
3360 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3361 {
3362 struct program_space *pspace;
3363 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3364
3365 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3366
3367 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3368 {
3369 struct objfile *objfile;
3370 CORE_ADDR addr;
3371
3372 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3373
3374 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3375 {
3376 struct breakpoint *b;
3377 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3378 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3379
3380 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3381
3382 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3383 continue;
3384
3385 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3386 {
3387 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3388
3389 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3390 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3391 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3392 {
3393 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3394 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3395 continue;
3396 }
3397 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3398 }
3399
3400 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3401 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3402 bp_std_terminate_master,
3403 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3404 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3405 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3406 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3407 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3408 }
3409 }
3410 }
3411
3412 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3413
3414 static void
3415 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3416 {
3417 struct objfile *objfile;
3418 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3419
3420 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3421 {
3422 struct breakpoint *b;
3423 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3424 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3425 CORE_ADDR addr;
3426 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3427
3428 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3429
3430 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3431 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3432 {
3433 std::vector<probe *> ret
3434 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3435
3436 if (!ret.empty ())
3437 {
3438 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3439 probe *p = ret[0];
3440
3441 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3442 {
3443 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3444 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3445 ret.clear ();
3446 }
3447 }
3448 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3449 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3450 }
3451
3452 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ())
3453 {
3454 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3455
3456 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes)
3457 {
3458 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3459 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3460 bp_exception_master,
3461 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3462 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3463 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3464 }
3465
3466 continue;
3467 }
3468
3469 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3470
3471 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3472 continue;
3473
3474 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3475
3476 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3477 {
3478 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3479
3480 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3481 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3482 {
3483 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3484 continue;
3485 }
3486
3487 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3488 }
3489
3490 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3491 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3492 current_top_target ());
3493 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3494 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3495 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3496 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3497 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3498 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3499 }
3500 }
3501
3502 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3503
3504 static int
3505 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
3506 {
3507 return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location.get ());
3508 }
3509
3510 void
3511 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3512 {
3513 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3514 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3515
3516 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3517 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3518 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3519 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3520 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3521 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3522 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3523 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3524 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3525 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3526 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3527
3528 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3529 {
3530 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3531 continue;
3532
3533 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3534 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3535 {
3536 delete_breakpoint (b);
3537 continue;
3538 }
3539
3540 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3541 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3542 {
3543 delete_breakpoint (b);
3544 continue;
3545 }
3546
3547 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3548 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3549 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3550 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3551 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3552 {
3553 delete_breakpoint (b);
3554 continue;
3555 }
3556
3557 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3558 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3559 {
3560 delete_breakpoint (b);
3561 continue;
3562 }
3563
3564 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3565 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3566 {
3567 delete_breakpoint (b);
3568 continue;
3569 }
3570
3571 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3572 after an exec. */
3573 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3574 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3575 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3576 {
3577 delete_breakpoint (b);
3578 continue;
3579 }
3580
3581 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3582 {
3583 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3584 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3585 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3586 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3587 continue;
3588 }
3589
3590 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3591 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3592 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3593 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3594 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3595 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3596
3597 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3598 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3599 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3600 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3601 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3602 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3603 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3604
3605 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3606 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3607 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3608 let finish_command delete it.
3609
3610 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3611 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3612 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3613 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3614 solib breakpoints.) */
3615
3616 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3617 {
3618 continue;
3619 }
3620
3621 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3622 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3623 a.out. */
3624 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
3625 {
3626 delete_breakpoint (b);
3627 continue;
3628 }
3629 }
3630 }
3631
3632 int
3633 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3634 {
3635 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3636 int val = 0;
3637 scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid);
3638 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3639
3640 if (ptid.pid () == inferior_ptid.pid ())
3641 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3642
3643 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3644 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3645 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3646 {
3647 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3648 continue;
3649
3650 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3651 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3652 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3653 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3654 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3655 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3656 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3657 continue;
3658
3659 if (bl->inserted)
3660 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3661 }
3662
3663 return val;
3664 }
3665
3666 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3667 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3668 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3669 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3670 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3671
3672 static int
3673 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
3674 {
3675 int val;
3676
3677 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3678 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3679
3680 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3681 This should not ever happen. */
3682 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3683
3684 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3685 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3686 {
3687 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3688 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3689 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3690
3691 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3692 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3693 || bl->section == NULL
3694 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3695 {
3696 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3697
3698 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3699 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3700 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3701 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3702 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3703 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3704 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3705 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3706 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3707 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3708 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3709 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3710 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3711 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3712 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3713 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3714 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3715 they should always be removed. */
3716 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3717 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3718 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3719 val = 0;
3720 else
3721 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3722 }
3723 else
3724 {
3725 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3726 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3727 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3728 {
3729 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3730 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3731 */
3732 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3733 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3734 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3735 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3736 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3737 else
3738 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3739 &bl->overlay_target_info,
3740 reason);
3741 }
3742 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3743 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3744 if (bl->inserted)
3745 {
3746 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3747 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3748 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3749 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3750
3751 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3752 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3753 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3754 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3755 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3756 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3757 else
3758 val = 0;
3759 }
3760 else
3761 {
3762 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3763 val = 0;
3764 }
3765 }
3766
3767 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3768 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3769 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3770 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3771 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3772 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3773 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3774 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3775 always-inserted mode. */
3776 if (val
3777 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3778 && (bl->shlib_disabled
3779 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
3780 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
3781 bl->address))))
3782 val = 0;
3783
3784 if (val)
3785 return val;
3786 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3787 }
3788 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3789 {
3790 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3791 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3792
3793 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3794 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3795
3796 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3797 if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
3798 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3799 bl->owner->number);
3800 }
3801 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
3802 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3803 && !bl->duplicate)
3804 {
3805 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3806 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3807
3808 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3809 if (val)
3810 return val;
3811
3812 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3813 }
3814
3815 return 0;
3816 }
3817
3818 static int
3819 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
3820 {
3821 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3822 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3823
3824 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3825 This should not ever happen. */
3826 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3827
3828 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
3829
3830 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3831
3832 return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
3833 }
3834
3835 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3836
3837 void
3838 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3839 {
3840 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3841
3842 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3843 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
3844 bl->inserted = 0;
3845 }
3846
3847 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3848 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3849
3850 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3851 between runs.
3852
3853 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3854 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3855 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3856
3857
3858
3859 void
3860 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
3861 {
3862 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3863 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
3864
3865 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3866 nothing to do. */
3867 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
3868 return;
3869
3870 mark_breakpoints_out ();
3871
3872 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3873 {
3874 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
3875 continue;
3876
3877 switch (b->type)
3878 {
3879 case bp_call_dummy:
3880 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
3881
3882 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
3883 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
3884 rid of it. */
3885
3886 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3887
3888 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
3889
3890 case bp_shlib_event:
3891
3892 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
3893 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
3894 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
3895 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
3896 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
3897
3898 (gdb) file prog-linux
3899 (gdb) run # native linux target
3900 ...
3901 (gdb) kill
3902 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
3903 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
3904 */
3905
3906 case bp_step_resume:
3907
3908 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
3909
3910 case bp_single_step:
3911
3912 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
3913
3914 delete_breakpoint (b);
3915 break;
3916
3917 case bp_watchpoint:
3918 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3919 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3920 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3921 {
3922 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
3923
3924 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
3925 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
3926 delete_breakpoint (b);
3927 else
3928 {
3929 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
3930 valid. New ones will be created in
3931 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
3932 The next update_global_location_list call will
3933 garbage collect them. */
3934 b->loc = NULL;
3935
3936 if (context == inf_starting)
3937 {
3938 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
3939 insert_breakpoints. */
3940 w->val.reset (nullptr);
3941 w->val_valid = 0;
3942 }
3943 }
3944 }
3945 break;
3946 default:
3947 break;
3948 }
3949 }
3950
3951 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
3952 for (bp_location *bl : moribund_locations)
3953 decref_bp_location (&bl);
3954 moribund_locations.clear ();
3955 }
3956
3957 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
3958 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
3959 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
3960 match, not program space. */
3961
3962 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
3963 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
3964 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
3965 permanent breakpoint.
3966 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
3967 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
3968 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
3969 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
3970 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
3971
3972 enum breakpoint_here
3973 breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
3974 {
3975 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3976 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
3977
3978 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3979 {
3980 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3981 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3982 continue;
3983
3984 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3985 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3986 || bl->permanent)
3987 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
3988 {
3989 if (overlay_debugging
3990 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3991 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3992 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
3993 else if (bl->permanent)
3994 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
3995 else
3996 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
3997 }
3998 }
3999
4000 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
4001 }
4002
4003 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4004
4005 int
4006 breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace,
4007 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4008 {
4009 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4010
4011 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4012 {
4013 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4014 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4015 continue;
4016
4017 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4018 || bl->permanent)
4019 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
4020 addr, len))
4021 {
4022 if (overlay_debugging
4023 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4024 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4025 {
4026 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
4027 continue;
4028 }
4029
4030 return 1;
4031 }
4032 }
4033
4034 return 0;
4035 }
4036
4037 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4038
4039 int
4040 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4041 {
4042 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
4043 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4044 return 1;
4045
4046 return 0;
4047 }
4048
4049 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4050 ASPACE. */
4051
4052 static int
4053 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4054 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4055 {
4056 if (bl->inserted
4057 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4058 aspace, pc))
4059 {
4060 if (overlay_debugging
4061 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4062 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4063 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4064 else
4065 return 1;
4066 }
4067 return 0;
4068 }
4069
4070 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4071
4072 int
4073 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4074 {
4075 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4076
4077 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4078 {
4079 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4080
4081 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4082 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4083 continue;
4084
4085 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4086 return 1;
4087 }
4088 return 0;
4089 }
4090
4091 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4092 inserted at PC. */
4093
4094 int
4095 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4096 CORE_ADDR pc)
4097 {
4098 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4099
4100 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4101 {
4102 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4103
4104 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4105 continue;
4106
4107 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4108 return 1;
4109 }
4110
4111 return 0;
4112 }
4113
4114 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4115
4116 int
4117 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4118 CORE_ADDR pc)
4119 {
4120 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4121
4122 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4123 {
4124 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4125
4126 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4127 continue;
4128
4129 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4130 return 1;
4131 }
4132
4133 return 0;
4134 }
4135
4136 int
4137 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace,
4138 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4139 {
4140 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4141
4142 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4143 {
4144 struct bp_location *loc;
4145
4146 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4147 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4148 continue;
4149
4150 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4151 continue;
4152
4153 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4154 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4155 {
4156 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4157
4158 /* Check for intersection. */
4159 l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
4160 h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4161 if (l < h)
4162 return 1;
4163 }
4164 }
4165 return 0;
4166 }
4167 \f
4168
4169 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
4170 in breakpoint.h. */
4171
4172 int
4173 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
4174 {
4175 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
4176 }
4177
4178 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4179 'next' chain. */
4180
4181 bpstats::~bpstats ()
4182 {
4183 if (bp_location_at != NULL)
4184 decref_bp_location (&bp_location_at);
4185 }
4186
4187 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4188 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4189
4190 void
4191 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4192 {
4193 bpstat p;
4194 bpstat q;
4195
4196 if (bsp == 0)
4197 return;
4198 p = *bsp;
4199 while (p != NULL)
4200 {
4201 q = p->next;
4202 delete p;
4203 p = q;
4204 }
4205 *bsp = NULL;
4206 }
4207
4208 bpstats::bpstats (const bpstats &other)
4209 : next (NULL),
4210 bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at),
4211 breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at),
4212 commands (other.commands),
4213 print (other.print),
4214 stop (other.stop),
4215 print_it (other.print_it)
4216 {
4217 if (other.old_val != NULL)
4218 old_val = release_value (value_copy (other.old_val.get ()));
4219 incref_bp_location (bp_location_at);
4220 }
4221
4222 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4223 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4224
4225 bpstat
4226 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4227 {
4228 bpstat p = NULL;
4229 bpstat tmp;
4230 bpstat retval = NULL;
4231
4232 if (bs == NULL)
4233 return bs;
4234
4235 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4236 {
4237 tmp = new bpstats (*bs);
4238
4239 if (p == NULL)
4240 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4241 retval = tmp;
4242 else
4243 p->next = tmp;
4244 p = tmp;
4245 }
4246 p->next = NULL;
4247 return retval;
4248 }
4249
4250 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4251
4252 bpstat
4253 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4254 {
4255 if (bsp == NULL)
4256 return NULL;
4257
4258 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4259 {
4260 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4261 return bsp;
4262 }
4263 return NULL;
4264 }
4265
4266 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4267
4268 int
4269 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4270 {
4271 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4272 {
4273 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4274 {
4275 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4276 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4277 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4278 return 1;
4279 }
4280 else
4281 {
4282 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4283 sig))
4284 return 1;
4285 }
4286 }
4287
4288 return 0;
4289 }
4290
4291 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4292 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4293 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4294 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4295
4296 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4297 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4298 we set it.
4299 Return 1 otherwise. */
4300
4301 int
4302 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4303 {
4304 struct breakpoint *b;
4305
4306 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4307 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4308
4309 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4310 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4311 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4312 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4313 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4314 if (b == NULL)
4315 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4316
4317 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4318 return 1;
4319 }
4320
4321 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4322
4323 void
4324 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4325 {
4326 bpstat bs;
4327
4328 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
4329 return;
4330
4331 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4332 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4333 {
4334 bs->commands = NULL;
4335 bs->old_val.reset (nullptr);
4336 }
4337 }
4338
4339 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4340
4341 static void
4342 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4343 {
4344 if (inferior_ptid != null_ptid)
4345 {
4346 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4347
4348 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4349 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4350 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4351 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4352 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4353 return;
4354 }
4355
4356 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4357 }
4358
4359 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4360 or its equivalent. */
4361
4362 static int
4363 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4364 {
4365 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4366 }
4367
4368 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4369 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4370 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4371 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4372
4373 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4374 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4375 bpstat of the current thread. */
4376
4377 static int
4378 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4379 {
4380 bpstat bs;
4381 int again = 0;
4382
4383 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4384 in bs->commands. */
4385 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4386 return 0;
4387
4388 scoped_restore save_executing
4389 = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1);
4390
4391 scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat ();
4392
4393 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4394 bs = *bsp;
4395
4396 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4397 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4398 {
4399 struct command_line *cmd = NULL;
4400
4401 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4402
4403 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4404 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4405 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4406 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4407 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4408 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4409 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4410 the tree when we're done. */
4411 counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands;
4412 bs->commands = NULL;
4413 if (ccmd != NULL)
4414 cmd = ccmd.get ();
4415 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4416 {
4417 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4418 cmd = cmd->next;
4419 }
4420
4421 while (cmd != NULL)
4422 {
4423 execute_control_command (cmd);
4424
4425 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4426 break;
4427 else
4428 cmd = cmd->next;
4429 }
4430
4431 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4432 {
4433 if (current_ui->async)
4434 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4435 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4436 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4437 ;
4438 else
4439 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4440 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4441 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4442 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4443 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4444 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4445 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4446 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4447 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4448 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4449 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4450 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4451 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4452 again = 1;
4453 break;
4454 }
4455 }
4456 return again;
4457 }
4458
4459 /* Helper for bpstat_do_actions. Get the current thread, if there's
4460 one, is alive and has execution. Return NULL otherwise. */
4461
4462 static thread_info *
4463 get_bpstat_thread ()
4464 {
4465 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution)
4466 return NULL;
4467
4468 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4469 if (tp->state == THREAD_EXITED || tp->executing)
4470 return NULL;
4471 return tp;
4472 }
4473
4474 void
4475 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4476 {
4477 struct cleanup *cleanup_if_error = make_bpstat_clear_actions_cleanup ();
4478 thread_info *tp;
4479
4480 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4481 while ((tp = get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL)
4482 {
4483 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the
4484 inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next
4485 breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns
4486 false to indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4487 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp->control.stop_bpstat))
4488 break;
4489 }
4490
4491 discard_cleanups (cleanup_if_error);
4492 }
4493
4494 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4495
4496 static void
4497 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4498 {
4499 if (val == NULL)
4500 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4501 else
4502 {
4503 struct value_print_options opts;
4504 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4505 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4506 }
4507 }
4508
4509 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4510 debugging multiple threads. */
4511
4512 void
4513 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
4514 {
4515 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4516 return;
4517
4518 uiout->text ("\n");
4519
4520 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4521 {
4522 const char *name;
4523 struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
4524
4525 uiout->text ("Thread ");
4526 uiout->field_fmt ("thread-id", "%s", print_thread_id (thr));
4527
4528 name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr);
4529 if (name != NULL)
4530 {
4531 uiout->text (" \"");
4532 uiout->field_fmt ("name", "%s", name);
4533 uiout->text ("\"");
4534 }
4535
4536 uiout->text (" hit ");
4537 }
4538 }
4539
4540 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4541 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4542 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4543 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4544 normal_stop(). */
4545
4546 static enum print_stop_action
4547 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4548 {
4549 switch (bs->print_it)
4550 {
4551 case print_it_noop:
4552 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4553 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4554 break;
4555
4556 case print_it_done:
4557 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4558 relevant messages. */
4559 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4560 break;
4561
4562 case print_it_normal:
4563 {
4564 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4565
4566 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4567 which has since been deleted. */
4568 if (b == NULL)
4569 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4570
4571 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4572 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4573 }
4574 break;
4575
4576 default:
4577 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4578 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4579 break;
4580 }
4581 }
4582
4583 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4584
4585 static void
4586 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4587 {
4588 bool any_deleted = !current_program_space->deleted_solibs.empty ();
4589 bool any_added = !current_program_space->added_solibs.empty ();
4590
4591 if (!is_catchpoint)
4592 {
4593 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4594 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4595 else
4596 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4597 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4598 }
4599
4600 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4601 current_uiout->field_string ("reason",
4602 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4603
4604 if (any_deleted)
4605 {
4606 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded "));
4607 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed");
4608 for (int ix = 0; ix < current_program_space->deleted_solibs.size (); ix++)
4609 {
4610 const std::string &name = current_program_space->deleted_solibs[ix];
4611
4612 if (ix > 0)
4613 current_uiout->text (" ");
4614 current_uiout->field_string ("library", name);
4615 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4616 }
4617 }
4618
4619 if (any_added)
4620 {
4621 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded "));
4622 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added");
4623 bool first = true;
4624 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
4625 {
4626 if (!first)
4627 current_uiout->text (" ");
4628 first = false;
4629 current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name);
4630 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4631 }
4632 }
4633 }
4634
4635 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4636 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4637 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4638 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4639 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4640 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4641 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4642 routine is one of:
4643
4644 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4645 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4646 code to print the location. An example is
4647 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4648 the location.
4649 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4650 to also print the location part of the message.
4651 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4652 don't require a location appended to the end.
4653 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4654 further info to be printed. */
4655
4656 enum print_stop_action
4657 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4658 {
4659 enum print_stop_action val;
4660
4661 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4662 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4663 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4664 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4665 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4666 {
4667 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4668 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4669 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4670 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4671 return val;
4672 }
4673
4674 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4675 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4676 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4677 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4678 {
4679 print_solib_event (0);
4680 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4681 }
4682
4683 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4684 with and nothing was printed. */
4685 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4686 }
4687
4688 /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */
4689
4690 static bool
4691 breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp)
4692 {
4693 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4694 bool res = value_true (evaluate_expression (exp));
4695
4696 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4697 return res;
4698 }
4699
4700 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4701
4702 bpstats::bpstats (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4703 : next (NULL),
4704 bp_location_at (bl),
4705 breakpoint_at (bl->owner),
4706 commands (NULL),
4707 print (0),
4708 stop (0),
4709 print_it (print_it_normal)
4710 {
4711 incref_bp_location (bl);
4712 **bs_link_pointer = this;
4713 *bs_link_pointer = &next;
4714 }
4715
4716 bpstats::bpstats ()
4717 : next (NULL),
4718 bp_location_at (NULL),
4719 breakpoint_at (NULL),
4720 commands (NULL),
4721 print (0),
4722 stop (0),
4723 print_it (print_it_normal)
4724 {
4725 }
4726 \f
4727 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4728 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4729
4730 int
4731 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4732 {
4733 bool stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4734 CORE_ADDR addr;
4735 struct breakpoint *b;
4736
4737 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4738 {
4739 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4740 as not triggered. */
4741 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4742 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4743 {
4744 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4745
4746 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4747 }
4748
4749 return 0;
4750 }
4751
4752 if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_top_target (), &addr))
4753 {
4754 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4755 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4756 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4757 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4758 {
4759 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4760
4761 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4762 }
4763
4764 return 1;
4765 }
4766
4767 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4768 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4769 triggered. */
4770
4771 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4772 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4773 {
4774 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4775 struct bp_location *loc;
4776
4777 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4778 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4779 {
4780 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4781 {
4782 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4783 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4784
4785 if (newaddr == start)
4786 {
4787 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4788 break;
4789 }
4790 }
4791 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4792 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (current_top_target (),
4793 addr, loc->address,
4794 loc->length))
4795 {
4796 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4797 break;
4798 }
4799 }
4800 }
4801
4802 return 1;
4803 }
4804
4805 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */
4806 enum wp_check_result
4807 {
4808 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4809 WP_DELETED = 1,
4810
4811 /* The value has changed. */
4812 WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2,
4813
4814 /* The value has not changed. */
4815 WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3,
4816
4817 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4818 WP_IGNORE = 4,
4819 };
4820
4821 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4822 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4823
4824 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4825 changed. */
4826
4827 static wp_check_result
4828 watchpoint_check (bpstat bs)
4829 {
4830 struct watchpoint *b;
4831 struct frame_info *fr;
4832 int within_current_scope;
4833
4834 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4835 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4836 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4837
4838 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4839 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4840 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4841 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4842 return WP_IGNORE;
4843
4844 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4845 within_current_scope = 1;
4846 else
4847 {
4848 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4849 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4850 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4851
4852 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4853 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4854 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4855 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4856 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4857 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4858 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4859 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4860 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4861 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
4862 return WP_IGNORE;
4863
4864 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
4865 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
4866
4867 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
4868 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
4869 if (within_current_scope)
4870 {
4871 struct symbol *function;
4872
4873 function = get_frame_function (fr);
4874 if (function == NULL
4875 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
4876 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
4877 within_current_scope = 0;
4878 }
4879
4880 if (within_current_scope)
4881 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
4882 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
4883 the user. */
4884 select_frame (fr);
4885 }
4886
4887 if (within_current_scope)
4888 {
4889 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
4890 time before we return to the command level and call
4891 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
4892 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
4893
4894 int pc = 0;
4895 struct value *mark;
4896 struct value *new_val;
4897
4898 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4899 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
4900 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
4901 a mask watchpoint. */
4902 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4903
4904 mark = value_mark ();
4905 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
4906
4907 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
4908 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
4909
4910 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
4911 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
4912 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
4913 not what we want. */
4914 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
4915 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val.get (),
4916 new_val)))
4917 {
4918 bs->old_val = b->val;
4919 b->val = release_value (new_val);
4920 b->val_valid = 1;
4921 if (new_val != NULL)
4922 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4923 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4924 }
4925 else
4926 {
4927 /* Nothing changed. */
4928 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4929 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
4930 }
4931 }
4932 else
4933 {
4934 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
4935 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
4936 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
4937 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
4938 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
4939 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
4940 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
4941 the first value assigned). */
4942 /* We print all the stop information in
4943 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
4944 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
4945 already. So we have no choice but print the information
4946 here. */
4947
4948 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
4949 {
4950 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
4951
4952 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4953 uiout->field_string
4954 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
4955 uiout->text ("\nWatchpoint ");
4956 uiout->field_int ("wpnum", b->number);
4957 uiout->text (" deleted because the program has left the block in\n"
4958 "which its expression is valid.\n");
4959 }
4960
4961 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
4962 b->commands = NULL;
4963 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
4964
4965 return WP_DELETED;
4966 }
4967 }
4968
4969 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
4970 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
4971 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
4972
4973 static int
4974 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
4975 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
4976 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4977 {
4978 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
4979
4980 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
4981 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
4982
4983 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
4984 }
4985
4986 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
4987 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
4988
4989 static void
4990 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
4991 {
4992 const struct bp_location *bl;
4993 struct watchpoint *b;
4994
4995 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
4996 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
4997 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
4998 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4999 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5000
5001 {
5002 int must_check_value = 0;
5003
5004 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5005 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5006 watched value. */
5007 must_check_value = 1;
5008 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5009 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5010 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5011 this watchpoint. */
5012 must_check_value = 1;
5013 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5014 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5015 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5016 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5017 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5018 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5019 must_check_value = 1;
5020
5021 if (must_check_value)
5022 {
5023 wp_check_result e;
5024
5025 TRY
5026 {
5027 e = watchpoint_check (bs);
5028 }
5029 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
5030 {
5031 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5032 "Error evaluating expression "
5033 "for watchpoint %d\n",
5034 b->number);
5035
5036 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5037 {
5038 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
5039 b->number);
5040 }
5041 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5042 e = WP_DELETED;
5043 }
5044 END_CATCH
5045
5046 switch (e)
5047 {
5048 case WP_DELETED:
5049 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5050 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5051 /* Stop. */
5052 break;
5053 case WP_IGNORE:
5054 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5055 bs->stop = 0;
5056 break;
5057 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5058 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5059 {
5060 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5061
5062 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5063 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5064 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5065 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5066 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5067 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5068 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5069 old value.
5070
5071 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5072 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5073 happen:
5074
5075 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5076 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5077 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5078 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5079
5080 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5081 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5082 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5083 watchpoint.
5084
5085 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5086 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5087 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5088 changes. This still gives false positives when
5089 the program writes the same value to memory as
5090 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5091 it for a read), but it's much better than
5092 nothing. */
5093
5094 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5095
5096 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5097 {
5098 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5099
5100 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5101 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5102 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5103 {
5104 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5105 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5106
5107 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5108 == watch_triggered_yes)
5109 {
5110 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5111 break;
5112 }
5113 }
5114 }
5115
5116 if (other_write_watchpoint
5117 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5118 {
5119 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5120 and the value changed since the last time we
5121 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5122 Ignore it. */
5123 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5124 bs->stop = 0;
5125 }
5126 }
5127 break;
5128 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5129 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5130 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5131 {
5132 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5133 the value hasn't changed. */
5134 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5135 bs->stop = 0;
5136 }
5137 /* Stop. */
5138 break;
5139 default:
5140 /* Can't happen. */
5141 break;
5142 }
5143 }
5144 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5145 {
5146 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5147 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5148 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5149 anything for this watchpoint. */
5150 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5151 bs->stop = 0;
5152 }
5153 }
5154 }
5155
5156 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5157 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5158 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5159 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5160
5161 static void
5162 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, thread_info *thread)
5163 {
5164 const struct bp_location *bl;
5165 struct breakpoint *b;
5166 /* Assume stop. */
5167 bool condition_result = true;
5168 struct expression *cond;
5169
5170 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5171
5172 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5173 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5174 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5175 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5176 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5177
5178 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5179 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5180 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5181
5182 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5183 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5184 {
5185 bs->stop = 0;
5186 return;
5187 }
5188
5189 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5190 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5191 thread/task. */
5192 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread->global_num)
5193 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (thread)))
5194 {
5195 bs->stop = 0;
5196 return;
5197 }
5198
5199 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5200 implemented. */
5201 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5202
5203 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5204 {
5205 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5206
5207 cond = w->cond_exp.get ();
5208 }
5209 else
5210 cond = bl->cond.get ();
5211
5212 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5213 {
5214 int within_current_scope = 1;
5215 struct watchpoint * w;
5216
5217 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5218 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5219 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5220 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5221 function call. */
5222 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5223
5224 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5225 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5226 else
5227 w = NULL;
5228
5229 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5230 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5231 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5232 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5233 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5234 call site. */
5235 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5236 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5237 else
5238 {
5239 struct frame_info *frame;
5240
5241 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5242 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5243 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5244 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5245 really matter which instantiation of the function
5246 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5247 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5248 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5249 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5250 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5251 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5252 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5253 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5254 intuitive. */
5255 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5256 if (frame != NULL)
5257 select_frame (frame);
5258 else
5259 within_current_scope = 0;
5260 }
5261 if (within_current_scope)
5262 {
5263 TRY
5264 {
5265 condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond);
5266 }
5267 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
5268 {
5269 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5270 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n");
5271 }
5272 END_CATCH
5273 }
5274 else
5275 {
5276 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5277 "in the current scope"));
5278 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5279 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5280 }
5281 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5282 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5283 }
5284
5285 if (cond && !condition_result)
5286 {
5287 bs->stop = 0;
5288 }
5289 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5290 {
5291 b->ignore_count--;
5292 bs->stop = 0;
5293 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5294 ++(b->hit_count);
5295 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5296 }
5297 }
5298
5299 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5300 on the current target. */
5301
5302 static int
5303 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5304 {
5305 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5306 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5307 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5308 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5309 }
5310
5311 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5312
5313 bpstat
5314 build_bpstat_chain (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5315 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5316 {
5317 struct breakpoint *b;
5318 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5319
5320 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5321 {
5322 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5323 continue;
5324
5325 for (bp_location *bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5326 {
5327 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5328 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5329 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5330 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5331 checked all locations already. */
5332 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5333 break;
5334
5335 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5336 continue;
5337
5338 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5339 continue;
5340
5341 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5342 matches. */
5343
5344 bpstat bs = new bpstats (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5345 explain stop. */
5346
5347 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5348 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5349 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5350 bs->stop = 1;
5351 bs->print = 1;
5352
5353 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5354 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5355 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5356 iteration. */
5357 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5358 {
5359 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5360
5361 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5362 }
5363 }
5364 }
5365
5366 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5367 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5368 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5369 {
5370 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
5371 {
5372 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5373 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5374 {
5375 bpstat bs = new bpstats (loc, &bs_link);
5376 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5377 bs->stop = 0;
5378 bs->print = 0;
5379 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5380 }
5381 }
5382 }
5383
5384 return bs_head;
5385 }
5386
5387 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5388
5389 bpstat
5390 bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace,
5391 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, thread_info *thread,
5392 const struct target_waitstatus *ws,
5393 bpstat stop_chain)
5394 {
5395 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5396 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5397 bpstat bs_head = stop_chain;
5398 bpstat bs;
5399 int need_remove_insert;
5400 int removed_any;
5401
5402 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5403 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5404 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5405 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5406 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5407 inferior function calls. */
5408 if (bs_head == NULL)
5409 bs_head = build_bpstat_chain (aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5410
5411 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5412 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5413 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5414 "catch unload". */
5415 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5416 {
5417 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5418 {
5419 handle_solib_event ();
5420 break;
5421 }
5422 }
5423
5424 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5425 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5426 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5427
5428 removed_any = 0;
5429
5430 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5431 {
5432 if (!bs->stop)
5433 continue;
5434
5435 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5436 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5437 if (bs->stop)
5438 {
5439 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, thread);
5440
5441 if (bs->stop)
5442 {
5443 ++(b->hit_count);
5444 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5445
5446 /* We will stop here. */
5447 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5448 {
5449 --(b->enable_count);
5450 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5451 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5452 removed_any = 1;
5453 }
5454 if (b->silent)
5455 bs->print = 0;
5456 bs->commands = b->commands;
5457 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5458 ? bs->commands.get () : NULL))
5459 bs->print = 0;
5460
5461 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5462 }
5463
5464 }
5465
5466 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5467 print. */
5468 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5469 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5470 }
5471
5472 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5473 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5474 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5475 done later. */
5476 need_remove_insert = 0;
5477 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5478 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5479 if (!bs->stop
5480 && bs->breakpoint_at
5481 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5482 {
5483 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5484
5485 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5486 need_remove_insert = 1;
5487 }
5488
5489 if (need_remove_insert)
5490 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5491 else if (removed_any)
5492 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5493
5494 return bs_head;
5495 }
5496
5497 static void
5498 handle_jit_event (void)
5499 {
5500 struct frame_info *frame;
5501 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5502
5503 if (debug_infrun)
5504 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "handling bp_jit_event\n");
5505
5506 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5507 breakpoint_re_set. */
5508 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
5509
5510 frame = get_current_frame ();
5511 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5512
5513 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5514
5515 target_terminal::inferior ();
5516 }
5517
5518 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5519
5520 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5521
5522 struct bpstat_what
5523 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5524 {
5525 struct bpstat_what retval;
5526 bpstat bs;
5527
5528 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5529 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5530 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5531
5532 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5533 {
5534 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5535 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5536 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5537 enum bptype bptype;
5538
5539 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5540 {
5541 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5542 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5543 bptype = bp_none;
5544 }
5545 else
5546 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5547
5548 switch (bptype)
5549 {
5550 case bp_none:
5551 break;
5552 case bp_breakpoint:
5553 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5554 case bp_single_step:
5555 case bp_until:
5556 case bp_finish:
5557 case bp_shlib_event:
5558 if (bs->stop)
5559 {
5560 if (bs->print)
5561 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5562 else
5563 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5564 }
5565 else
5566 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5567 break;
5568 case bp_watchpoint:
5569 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5570 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5571 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5572 if (bs->stop)
5573 {
5574 if (bs->print)
5575 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5576 else
5577 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5578 }
5579 else
5580 {
5581 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5582 This requires no further action. */
5583 }
5584 break;
5585 case bp_longjmp:
5586 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5587 case bp_exception:
5588 if (bs->stop)
5589 {
5590 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5591 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5592 }
5593 else
5594 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5595 break;
5596 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5597 case bp_exception_resume:
5598 if (bs->stop)
5599 {
5600 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5601 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5602 }
5603 else
5604 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5605 break;
5606 case bp_step_resume:
5607 if (bs->stop)
5608 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5609 else
5610 {
5611 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5612 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5613 }
5614 break;
5615 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5616 if (bs->stop)
5617 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5618 else
5619 {
5620 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5621 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5622 }
5623 break;
5624 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5625 case bp_thread_event:
5626 case bp_overlay_event:
5627 case bp_longjmp_master:
5628 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5629 case bp_exception_master:
5630 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5631 break;
5632 case bp_catchpoint:
5633 if (bs->stop)
5634 {
5635 if (bs->print)
5636 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5637 else
5638 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5639 }
5640 else
5641 {
5642 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5643 This requires no further action. */
5644 }
5645 break;
5646 case bp_jit_event:
5647 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5648 break;
5649 case bp_call_dummy:
5650 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5651 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5652 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5653 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5654 break;
5655 case bp_std_terminate:
5656 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5657 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5658 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5659 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5660 break;
5661 case bp_tracepoint:
5662 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5663 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5664 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5665 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5666 out already. */
5667 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5668 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5669 break;
5670 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5671 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5672 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5673 break;
5674 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5675 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5676 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5677 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5678 break;
5679
5680 case bp_dprintf:
5681 if (bs->stop)
5682 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5683 else
5684 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5685 break;
5686
5687 default:
5688 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5689 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5690 }
5691
5692 retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5693 }
5694
5695 return retval;
5696 }
5697
5698 void
5699 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
5700 {
5701 bpstat bs;
5702
5703 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5704 {
5705 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5706
5707 if (b == NULL)
5708 continue;
5709 switch (b->type)
5710 {
5711 case bp_jit_event:
5712 handle_jit_event ();
5713 break;
5714 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5715 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5716 break;
5717 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5718 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5719 break;
5720 }
5721 }
5722 }
5723
5724 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
5725 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
5726 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
5727
5728 int
5729 bpstat_should_step (void)
5730 {
5731 struct breakpoint *b;
5732
5733 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5734 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5735 return 1;
5736 return 0;
5737 }
5738
5739 int
5740 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5741 {
5742 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5743 if (bs->stop)
5744 return 1;
5745
5746 return 0;
5747 }
5748
5749 \f
5750
5751 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5752 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5753 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5754
5755 static char *
5756 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5757 {
5758 static char wrap_indent[80];
5759 int i, total_width, width, align;
5760 const char *text;
5761
5762 total_width = 0;
5763 for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5764 {
5765 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5766 {
5767 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5768 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5769 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5770
5771 return wrap_indent;
5772 }
5773
5774 total_width += width + 1;
5775 }
5776
5777 return NULL;
5778 }
5779
5780 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5781 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5782
5783 "host": Host evals condition.
5784 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5785 "target": Target evals condition.
5786 */
5787
5788 static const char *
5789 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5790 {
5791 struct bp_location *bl;
5792 char host_evals = 0;
5793 char target_evals = 0;
5794
5795 if (!b)
5796 return NULL;
5797
5798 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5799 return NULL;
5800
5801 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5802 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5803 return condition_evaluation_host;
5804
5805 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5806 {
5807 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5808 target_evals++;
5809 else
5810 host_evals++;
5811 }
5812
5813 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5814 return condition_evaluation_both;
5815 else if (target_evals)
5816 return condition_evaluation_target;
5817 else
5818 return condition_evaluation_host;
5819 }
5820
5821 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5822 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5823
5824 static const char *
5825 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5826 {
5827 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5828 return NULL;
5829
5830 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5831 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5832 return condition_evaluation_host;
5833
5834 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5835 return condition_evaluation_target;
5836 else
5837 return condition_evaluation_host;
5838 }
5839
5840 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5841
5842 static void
5843 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5844 struct bp_location *loc)
5845 {
5846 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5847
5848 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
5849
5850 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5851 loc = NULL;
5852
5853 if (loc != NULL)
5854 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5855
5856 if (b->display_canonical)
5857 uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5858 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
5859 {
5860 const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol;
5861
5862 if (sym)
5863 {
5864 uiout->text ("in ");
5865 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
5866 uiout->text (" ");
5867 uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5868 uiout->text ("at ");
5869 }
5870 uiout->field_string ("file",
5871 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab));
5872 uiout->text (":");
5873
5874 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5875 uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
5876
5877 uiout->field_int ("line", loc->line_number);
5878 }
5879 else if (loc)
5880 {
5881 string_file stb;
5882
5883 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb,
5884 demangle, "");
5885 uiout->field_stream ("at", stb);
5886 }
5887 else
5888 {
5889 uiout->field_string ("pending",
5890 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5891 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
5892 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
5893 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
5894 if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL)
5895 {
5896 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
5897 uiout->text (",");
5898 else
5899 uiout->text (" ");
5900 uiout->text (b->extra_string);
5901 }
5902 }
5903
5904 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
5905 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5906 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
5907 {
5908 uiout->text (" (");
5909 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
5910 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
5911 uiout->text (")");
5912 }
5913 }
5914
5915 static const char *
5916 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
5917 {
5918 struct ep_type_description
5919 {
5920 enum bptype type;
5921 const char *description;
5922 };
5923 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
5924 {
5925 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
5926 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
5927 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
5928 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
5929 {bp_until, "until"},
5930 {bp_finish, "finish"},
5931 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
5932 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
5933 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
5934 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
5935 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
5936 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
5937 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
5938 {bp_exception, "exception"},
5939 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
5940 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
5941 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
5942 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
5943 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
5944 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
5945 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
5946 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
5947 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
5948 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
5949 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
5950 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
5951 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
5952 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
5953 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
5954 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
5955 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
5956 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
5957 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
5958 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
5959 };
5960
5961 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
5962 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
5963 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5964 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
5965 (int) type);
5966
5967 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
5968 }
5969
5970 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
5971 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
5972
5973 static void
5974 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
5975 const char *field_name,
5976 const std::vector<int> &inf_nums,
5977 int mi_only)
5978 {
5979 int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p ();
5980
5981 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
5982 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
5983 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
5984 return;
5985
5986 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name);
5987
5988 for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++)
5989 {
5990 if (is_mi)
5991 {
5992 char mi_group[10];
5993
5994 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]);
5995 uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group);
5996 }
5997 else
5998 {
5999 if (i == 0)
6000 uiout->text (" inf ");
6001 else
6002 uiout->text (", ");
6003
6004 uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i]));
6005 }
6006 }
6007 }
6008
6009 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
6010
6011 static void
6012 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6013 struct bp_location *loc,
6014 int loc_number,
6015 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6016 int allflag)
6017 {
6018 struct command_line *l;
6019 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6020
6021 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6022 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6023 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6024 struct value_print_options opts;
6025
6026 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6027
6028 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6029 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6030 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6031 if (loc == NULL
6032 && (b->loc != NULL
6033 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6034 header_of_multiple = 1;
6035 if (loc == NULL)
6036 loc = b->loc;
6037
6038 annotate_record ();
6039
6040 /* 1 */
6041 annotate_field (0);
6042 if (part_of_multiple)
6043 uiout->field_fmt ("number", "%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6044 else
6045 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
6046
6047 /* 2 */
6048 annotate_field (1);
6049 if (part_of_multiple)
6050 uiout->field_skip ("type");
6051 else
6052 uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type));
6053
6054 /* 3 */
6055 annotate_field (2);
6056 if (part_of_multiple)
6057 uiout->field_skip ("disp");
6058 else
6059 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6060
6061 /* 4 */
6062 annotate_field (3);
6063 if (part_of_multiple)
6064 uiout->field_string ("enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6065 else
6066 uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6067
6068 /* 5 and 6 */
6069 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6070 {
6071 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
6072 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
6073 make sure there's just one location. */
6074 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
6075 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6076 }
6077 else
6078 switch (b->type)
6079 {
6080 case bp_none:
6081 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6082 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
6083 break;
6084
6085 case bp_watchpoint:
6086 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6087 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6088 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6089 {
6090 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6091
6092 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6093 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6094 is relatively readable). */
6095 if (opts.addressprint)
6096 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
6097 annotate_field (5);
6098 uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string);
6099 }
6100 break;
6101
6102 case bp_breakpoint:
6103 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6104 case bp_single_step:
6105 case bp_until:
6106 case bp_finish:
6107 case bp_longjmp:
6108 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6109 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6110 case bp_exception:
6111 case bp_exception_resume:
6112 case bp_step_resume:
6113 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6114 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6115 case bp_call_dummy:
6116 case bp_std_terminate:
6117 case bp_shlib_event:
6118 case bp_thread_event:
6119 case bp_overlay_event:
6120 case bp_longjmp_master:
6121 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6122 case bp_exception_master:
6123 case bp_tracepoint:
6124 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6125 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6126 case bp_dprintf:
6127 case bp_jit_event:
6128 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6129 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6130 if (opts.addressprint)
6131 {
6132 annotate_field (4);
6133 if (header_of_multiple)
6134 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
6135 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6136 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>");
6137 else
6138 uiout->field_core_addr ("addr",
6139 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6140 }
6141 annotate_field (5);
6142 if (!header_of_multiple)
6143 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6144 if (b->loc)
6145 *last_loc = b->loc;
6146 break;
6147 }
6148
6149
6150 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6151 {
6152 struct inferior *inf;
6153 std::vector<int> inf_nums;
6154 int mi_only = 1;
6155
6156 ALL_INFERIORS (inf)
6157 {
6158 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6159 inf_nums.push_back (inf->num);
6160 }
6161
6162 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6163 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6164 if (allflag
6165 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6166 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6167 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6168 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6169 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6170 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6171 mi_only = 0;
6172 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only);
6173 }
6174
6175 if (!part_of_multiple)
6176 {
6177 if (b->thread != -1)
6178 {
6179 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6180 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6181 uiout->text (" thread ");
6182 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6183 }
6184 else if (b->task != 0)
6185 {
6186 uiout->text (" task ");
6187 uiout->field_int ("task", b->task);
6188 }
6189 }
6190
6191 uiout->text ("\n");
6192
6193 if (!part_of_multiple)
6194 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6195
6196 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6197 {
6198 annotate_field (6);
6199 uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6200 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6201 the frame ID. */
6202 uiout->field_core_addr ("frame",
6203 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6204 uiout->text ("\n");
6205 }
6206
6207 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6208 {
6209 annotate_field (7);
6210 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6211 uiout->text ("\ttrace only if ");
6212 else
6213 uiout->text ("\tstop only if ");
6214 uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string);
6215
6216 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6217 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6218 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6219 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6220 == condition_evaluation_target)
6221 {
6222 uiout->text (" (");
6223 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
6224 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
6225 uiout->text (" evals)");
6226 }
6227 uiout->text ("\n");
6228 }
6229
6230 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6231 {
6232 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6233 uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread ");
6234 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6235 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6236 else
6237 {
6238 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
6239
6240 uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr));
6241 }
6242 uiout->text ("\n");
6243 }
6244
6245 if (!part_of_multiple)
6246 {
6247 if (b->hit_count)
6248 {
6249 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6250 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6251 uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint");
6252 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6253 uiout->text ("\ttracepoint");
6254 else
6255 uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint");
6256 uiout->text (" already hit ");
6257 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6258 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6259 uiout->text (" time\n");
6260 else
6261 uiout->text (" times\n");
6262 }
6263 else
6264 {
6265 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6266 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6267 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6268 }
6269 }
6270
6271 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6272 {
6273 annotate_field (8);
6274 uiout->text ("\tignore next ");
6275 uiout->field_int ("ignore", b->ignore_count);
6276 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6277 }
6278
6279 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6280 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6281 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6282 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6283 {
6284 annotate_field (8);
6285 uiout->text ("\tdisable after ");
6286 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6287 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6288 if (b->ignore_count)
6289 uiout->text ("additional ");
6290 else
6291 uiout->text ("next ");
6292 uiout->field_int ("enable", b->enable_count);
6293 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6294 }
6295
6296 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6297 {
6298 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6299
6300 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6301 {
6302 uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage ");
6303 uiout->field_int ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6304 uiout->text (" bytes\n");
6305 }
6306 }
6307
6308 l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
6309 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6310 {
6311 annotate_field (9);
6312 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "script");
6313 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6314 }
6315
6316 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6317 {
6318 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6319
6320 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6321 {
6322 annotate_field (10);
6323 uiout->text ("\tpass count ");
6324 uiout->field_int ("pass", t->pass_count);
6325 uiout->text (" \n");
6326 }
6327
6328 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6329 pending. */
6330 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6331 {
6332 annotate_field (11);
6333
6334 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6335 uiout->field_string ("installed",
6336 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6337 else
6338 {
6339 if (loc->inserted)
6340 uiout->text ("\t");
6341 else
6342 uiout->text ("\tnot ");
6343 uiout->text ("installed on target\n");
6344 }
6345 }
6346 }
6347
6348 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple)
6349 {
6350 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6351 {
6352 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6353
6354 uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string);
6355 }
6356 else if (b->location != NULL
6357 && event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()) != NULL)
6358 uiout->field_string ("original-location",
6359 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
6360 }
6361 }
6362
6363 static void
6364 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6365 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6366 int allflag)
6367 {
6368 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6369
6370 {
6371 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "bkpt");
6372
6373 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
6374 }
6375
6376 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6377 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6378 locations, if any. */
6379 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
6380 {
6381 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6382 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6383 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6384 situation.
6385
6386 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6387 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
6388 if (b->loc
6389 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6390 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
6391 {
6392 struct bp_location *loc;
6393 int n = 1;
6394
6395 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6396 {
6397 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL);
6398 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
6399 }
6400 }
6401 }
6402 }
6403
6404 static int
6405 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6406 {
6407 int print_address_bits = 0;
6408 struct bp_location *loc;
6409
6410 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6411 address to print. */
6412 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
6413 return 0;
6414
6415 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6416 {
6417 int addr_bit;
6418
6419 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6420 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6421 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6422 }
6423
6424 return print_address_bits;
6425 }
6426
6427 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6428
6429 void
6430 print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b)
6431 {
6432 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6433 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6434 }
6435
6436 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6437 internal or momentary. */
6438
6439 int
6440 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6441 {
6442 return b->number > 0;
6443 }
6444
6445 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6446
6447 int
6448 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6449 {
6450 return b->loc == NULL;
6451 }
6452
6453 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
6454 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
6455 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
6456 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6457 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
6458 breakpoints listed. */
6459
6460 static int
6461 breakpoint_1 (const char *args, int allflag,
6462 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6463 {
6464 struct breakpoint *b;
6465 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6466 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6467 struct value_print_options opts;
6468 int print_address_bits = 0;
6469 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6470 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6471
6472 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6473
6474 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6475 required for address fields. */
6476 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6477 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6478 {
6479 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6480 if (filter && !filter (b))
6481 continue;
6482
6483 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6484 accept. Skip the others. */
6485 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6486 {
6487 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6488 continue;
6489 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6490 continue;
6491 }
6492
6493 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6494 {
6495 int addr_bit, type_len;
6496
6497 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6498 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6499 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6500
6501 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6502 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6503 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6504
6505 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6506 }
6507 }
6508
6509 {
6510 ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout,
6511 opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5,
6512 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6513 "BreakpointTable");
6514
6515 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6516 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6517 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6518 annotate_field (0);
6519 uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6520 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6521 annotate_field (1);
6522 uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6523 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6524 annotate_field (2);
6525 uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6526 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6527 annotate_field (3);
6528 uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6529 if (opts.addressprint)
6530 {
6531 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6532 annotate_field (4);
6533 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6534 uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6535 else
6536 uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6537 }
6538 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6539 annotate_field (5);
6540 uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6541 uiout->table_body ();
6542 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6543 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6544
6545 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6546 {
6547 QUIT;
6548 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6549 if (filter && !filter (b))
6550 continue;
6551
6552 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6553 accept. Skip the others. */
6554
6555 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6556 {
6557 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6558 {
6559 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6560 continue;
6561 }
6562 else /* all others */
6563 {
6564 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6565 continue;
6566 }
6567 }
6568 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6569 allflag is set. */
6570 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6571 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6572 }
6573 }
6574
6575 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6576 {
6577 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6578 empty list. */
6579 if (!filter)
6580 {
6581 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6582 uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6583 else
6584 uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6585 args);
6586 }
6587 }
6588 else
6589 {
6590 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6591 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6592 }
6593
6594 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6595 there have been breakpoints? */
6596 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6597
6598 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6599 }
6600
6601 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6602 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6603
6604 static void
6605 default_collect_info (void)
6606 {
6607 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6608
6609 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6610 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6611 not wanted. */
6612 if (!*default_collect)
6613 return;
6614
6615 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6616 actions. */
6617 uiout->text ("default collect ");
6618 uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect);
6619 uiout->text (" \n");
6620 }
6621
6622 static void
6623 info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6624 {
6625 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
6626
6627 default_collect_info ();
6628 }
6629
6630 static void
6631 info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6632 {
6633 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
6634 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6635
6636 if (num_printed == 0)
6637 {
6638 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6639 uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n");
6640 else
6641 uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6642 }
6643 }
6644
6645 static void
6646 maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty)
6647 {
6648 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
6649
6650 default_collect_info ();
6651 }
6652
6653 static int
6654 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6655 struct program_space *pspace,
6656 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6657 {
6658 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
6659
6660 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
6661 {
6662 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6663 && bl->address == pc
6664 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6665 return 1;
6666 }
6667 return 0;
6668 }
6669
6670 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6671 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6672 address spaces. */
6673
6674 static void
6675 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6676 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6677 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6678 {
6679 int others = 0;
6680 struct breakpoint *b;
6681
6682 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6683 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6684 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6685 if (others > 0)
6686 {
6687 if (others == 1)
6688 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6689 else /* if (others == ???) */
6690 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6691 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6692 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6693 {
6694 others--;
6695 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6696 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6697 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6698 else if (b->thread != -1)
6699 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6700 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6701 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6702 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6703 ? " (disabled)"
6704 : ""),
6705 (others > 1) ? ","
6706 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6707 }
6708 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
6709 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
6710 printf_filtered (".\n");
6711 }
6712 }
6713 \f
6714
6715 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
6716 BPT locations. For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members
6717 are irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to other
6718 addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6719
6720 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
6721 always have a zero valued location address and we don't want to mark
6722 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
6723 breakpoint location at address zero:
6724
6725 bp_watchpoint
6726 bp_catchpoint
6727
6728 */
6729
6730 static int
6731 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6732 {
6733 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
6734
6735 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
6736 }
6737
6738 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6739 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6740
6741 static int
6742 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6743 struct bp_location *loc2)
6744 {
6745 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6746 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6747
6748 /* Both of them must exist. */
6749 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6750 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6751
6752 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6753 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6754 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6755 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6756 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6757 other watchpoint. */
6758 if ((w1->cond_exp
6759 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6760 loc1->length,
6761 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6762 w1->cond_exp.get ()))
6763 || (w2->cond_exp
6764 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6765 loc2->length,
6766 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6767 w2->cond_exp.get ())))
6768 return 0;
6769
6770 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6771 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6772 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6773 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6774 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6775 become hw_access locations later. */
6776 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6777 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6778 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6779 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6780 }
6781
6782 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6783
6784 int
6785 breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6786 const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6787 {
6788 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6789 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6790 && addr1 == addr2);
6791 }
6792
6793 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6794 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6795 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6796 space doesn't really matter. */
6797
6798 static int
6799 breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1,
6800 CORE_ADDR addr1,
6801 int len1, const address_space *aspace2,
6802 CORE_ADDR addr2)
6803 {
6804 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6805 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6806 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6807 }
6808
6809 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6810 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6811 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6812 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6813
6814 static int
6815 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6816 const address_space *aspace,
6817 CORE_ADDR addr)
6818 {
6819 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6820 aspace, addr)
6821 || (bl->length
6822 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6823 bl->address, bl->length,
6824 aspace, addr)));
6825 }
6826
6827 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
6828 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
6829 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
6830 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
6831 doesn't really matter. */
6832
6833 static int
6834 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
6835 const address_space *aspace,
6836 CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
6837 {
6838 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6839 || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
6840 {
6841 int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
6842
6843 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
6844 return 1;
6845 }
6846 return 0;
6847 }
6848
6849 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6850 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6851 true, otherwise returns false. */
6852
6853 static int
6854 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6855 struct bp_location *loc2)
6856 {
6857 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6858 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6859 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6860 different locations. */
6861 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6862 else
6863 return 0;
6864 }
6865
6866 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6867 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
6868 represent the same location. */
6869
6870 static int
6871 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6872 struct bp_location *loc2)
6873 {
6874 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
6875
6876 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6877 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
6878 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
6879
6880 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
6881 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
6882
6883 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
6884 return 0;
6885 else if (hw_point1)
6886 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6887 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6888 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6889 else
6890 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
6891 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
6892 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
6893 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6894 }
6895
6896 static void
6897 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
6898 int bnum, int have_bnum)
6899 {
6900 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
6901 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
6902 char astr1[64];
6903 char astr2[64];
6904
6905 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
6906 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
6907 if (have_bnum)
6908 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
6909 bnum, astr1, astr2);
6910 else
6911 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
6912 }
6913
6914 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
6915 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
6916 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
6917 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
6918
6919 static CORE_ADDR
6920 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6921 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
6922 {
6923 if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
6924 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6925 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
6926 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
6927 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
6928 {
6929 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
6930 have their addresses modified. */
6931 return bpaddr;
6932 }
6933 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
6934 {
6935 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
6936 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
6937 applies to this address, then it should have already been
6938 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
6939 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
6940 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
6941 return bpaddr;
6942 }
6943 else
6944 {
6945 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr;
6946
6947 if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
6948 {
6949 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
6950 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
6951 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
6952 }
6953
6954 adjusted_bpaddr = address_significant (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr);
6955
6956 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
6957 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
6958 is required. */
6959 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
6960 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
6961
6962 return adjusted_bpaddr;
6963 }
6964 }
6965
6966 bp_location::bp_location (const bp_location_ops *ops, breakpoint *owner)
6967 {
6968 bp_location *loc = this;
6969
6970 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
6971
6972 loc->ops = ops;
6973 loc->owner = owner;
6974 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
6975 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
6976 loc->enabled = 1;
6977
6978 switch (owner->type)
6979 {
6980 case bp_breakpoint:
6981 case bp_single_step:
6982 case bp_until:
6983 case bp_finish:
6984 case bp_longjmp:
6985 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6986 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6987 case bp_exception:
6988 case bp_exception_resume:
6989 case bp_step_resume:
6990 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6991 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6992 case bp_call_dummy:
6993 case bp_std_terminate:
6994 case bp_shlib_event:
6995 case bp_thread_event:
6996 case bp_overlay_event:
6997 case bp_jit_event:
6998 case bp_longjmp_master:
6999 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7000 case bp_exception_master:
7001 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7002 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7003 case bp_dprintf:
7004 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7005 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7006 break;
7007 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7008 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7009 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7010 break;
7011 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7012 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7013 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7014 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7015 break;
7016 case bp_watchpoint:
7017 case bp_catchpoint:
7018 case bp_tracepoint:
7019 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7020 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7021 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
7022 break;
7023 default:
7024 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7025 }
7026
7027 loc->refc = 1;
7028 }
7029
7030 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7031
7032 static struct bp_location *
7033 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7034 {
7035 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7036 }
7037
7038 static void
7039 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
7040 {
7041 loc->ops->dtor (loc);
7042 delete loc;
7043 }
7044
7045 /* Increment reference count. */
7046
7047 static void
7048 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7049 {
7050 ++bl->refc;
7051 }
7052
7053 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7054 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7055
7056 static void
7057 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7058 {
7059 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7060
7061 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7062 free_bp_location (*blp);
7063 *blp = NULL;
7064 }
7065
7066 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7067
7068 static breakpoint *
7069 add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b)
7070 {
7071 struct breakpoint *b1;
7072 struct breakpoint *result = b.get ();
7073
7074 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7075 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7076
7077 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7078 if (b1 == 0)
7079 breakpoint_chain = b.release ();
7080 else
7081 {
7082 while (b1->next)
7083 b1 = b1->next;
7084 b1->next = b.release ();
7085 }
7086
7087 return result;
7088 }
7089
7090 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7091
7092 static void
7093 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7094 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7095 enum bptype bptype,
7096 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7097 {
7098 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7099
7100 b->ops = ops;
7101 b->type = bptype;
7102 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7103 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7104 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7105 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7106 }
7107
7108 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7109 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7110
7111 static struct breakpoint *
7112 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7113 enum bptype bptype,
7114 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7115 {
7116 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7117
7118 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7119 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7120 }
7121
7122 /* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
7123 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
7124 enough. */
7125
7126 static void
7127 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
7128 {
7129 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7130
7131 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7132 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7133 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7134 {
7135 const char *function_name;
7136
7137 if (loc->msymbol != NULL
7138 && (MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_text_gnu_ifunc
7139 || MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_data_gnu_ifunc)
7140 && !explicit_loc)
7141 {
7142 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7143
7144 function_name = MSYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (loc->msymbol);
7145
7146 if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7147 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7148 {
7149 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7150 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7151 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7152 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7153 breakpoint. */
7154 loc->related_address = loc->address;
7155 }
7156 }
7157 else
7158 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &function_name, NULL, NULL);
7159
7160 if (function_name)
7161 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7162 }
7163 }
7164
7165 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7166 struct gdbarch *
7167 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7168 {
7169 if (sal.section)
7170 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7171 if (sal.symtab)
7172 return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab));
7173
7174 return NULL;
7175 }
7176
7177 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7178 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7179 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7180
7181 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7182 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7183 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7184
7185 static void
7186 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7187 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7188 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7189 {
7190 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7191
7192 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7193
7194 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7195 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7196
7197 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7198 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7199 program space. */
7200 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7201 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7202 }
7203
7204 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7205 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7206 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7207 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7208 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7209 is also returned as the value of this function.
7210
7211 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7212 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7213 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7214 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7215 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7216 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7217 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7218
7219 struct breakpoint *
7220 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7221 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7222 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7223 {
7224 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7225
7226 init_raw_breakpoint (b.get (), gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7227 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7228 }
7229
7230 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7231 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7232 initiated the operation. */
7233
7234 void
7235 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7236 {
7237 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7238 int thread = tp->global_num;
7239
7240 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7241 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7242 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7243 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7244 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7245 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7246 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7247 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7248 {
7249 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7250 struct breakpoint *clone;
7251
7252 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7253 after their removal. */
7254 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7255 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7256 clone->thread = thread;
7257 }
7258
7259 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7260 }
7261
7262 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7263 void
7264 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7265 {
7266 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7267
7268 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7269 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7270 {
7271 if (b->thread == thread)
7272 delete_breakpoint (b);
7273 }
7274 }
7275
7276 void
7277 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7278 {
7279 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7280
7281 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7282 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7283 {
7284 if (b->thread == thread)
7285 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7286 }
7287 }
7288
7289 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7290 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7291 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7292 breakpoints. */
7293
7294 struct breakpoint *
7295 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7296 {
7297 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7298
7299 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7300 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7301 {
7302 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7303
7304 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7305 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7306 1);
7307 new_b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
7308
7309 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7310
7311 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7312 if (retval == NULL)
7313 retval = new_b;
7314 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7315 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7316 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7317 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7318 }
7319
7320 return retval;
7321 }
7322
7323 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7324 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7325 stack.
7326
7327 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7328 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7329 frames. */
7330
7331 void
7332 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7333 {
7334 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7335
7336 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7337 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
7338 {
7339 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7340
7341 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7342 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7343 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7344 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7345 continue;
7346
7347 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp);
7348
7349 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7350 {
7351 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7352 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7353 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7354 }
7355 delete_breakpoint (b);
7356 }
7357 }
7358
7359 void
7360 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7361 {
7362 struct breakpoint *b;
7363
7364 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7365 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7366 {
7367 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7368 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7369 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7370 }
7371 }
7372
7373 void
7374 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7375 {
7376 struct breakpoint *b;
7377
7378 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7379 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7380 {
7381 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7382 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7383 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7384 }
7385 }
7386
7387 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7388 master breakpoint. */
7389 void
7390 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7391 {
7392 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7393
7394 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7395 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7396 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7397 {
7398 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7399 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7400 }
7401 }
7402
7403 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7404 void
7405 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7406 {
7407 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7408
7409 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7410 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7411 delete_breakpoint (b);
7412 }
7413
7414 struct breakpoint *
7415 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7416 {
7417 struct breakpoint *b;
7418
7419 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7420 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7421
7422 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7423 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7424 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
7425
7426 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7427
7428 return b;
7429 }
7430
7431 struct lang_and_radix
7432 {
7433 enum language lang;
7434 int radix;
7435 };
7436
7437 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7438
7439 struct breakpoint *
7440 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7441 {
7442 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7443 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7444 }
7445
7446 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7447
7448 void
7449 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7450 {
7451 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7452
7453 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7454 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7455 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7456 delete_breakpoint (b);
7457 }
7458
7459 void
7460 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7461 {
7462 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7463
7464 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7465 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7466 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7467 delete_breakpoint (b);
7468 }
7469
7470 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7471
7472 void
7473 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7474 {
7475 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7476
7477 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7478 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7479 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7480 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7481 }
7482
7483 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7484 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7485 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7486
7487 static struct breakpoint *
7488 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7489 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7490 {
7491 struct breakpoint *b;
7492
7493 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7494 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7495 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7496 return b;
7497 }
7498
7499 struct breakpoint *
7500 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7501 {
7502 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7503 }
7504
7505 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7506
7507 struct breakpoint *
7508 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7509 {
7510 struct breakpoint *b;
7511
7512 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7513 locations. */
7514 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7515 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7516 {
7517 delete_breakpoint (b);
7518 return NULL;
7519 }
7520 return b;
7521 }
7522
7523 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7524 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7525
7526 void
7527 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7528 {
7529 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7530
7531 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7532 {
7533 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7534 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7535
7536 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7537 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7538 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7539 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7540 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7541 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7542 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7543 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7544 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7545 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7546 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7547 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7548 )
7549 {
7550 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7551 }
7552 }
7553 }
7554
7555 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7556 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7557 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7558
7559 static void
7560 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7561 {
7562 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7563 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7564
7565 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7566 {
7567 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7568 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7569
7570 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7571 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7572 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7573 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7574 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7575 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7576 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7577 || is_tracepoint (b))
7578 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7579 {
7580 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7581 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7582 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7583 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7584 loc->inserted = 0;
7585
7586 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7587 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7588
7589 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7590 {
7591 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
7592 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7593 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7594 solib->so_name);
7595 }
7596 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7597 }
7598 }
7599 }
7600
7601 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7602 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7603 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7604
7605 static void
7606 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7607 {
7608 struct breakpoint *b;
7609
7610 if (objfile == NULL)
7611 return;
7612
7613 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7614 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7615 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7616 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7617 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7618 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7619 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7620 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7621 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7622 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7623 main objfile). */
7624 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7625 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7626 return;
7627
7628 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7629 {
7630 struct bp_location *loc;
7631 int bp_modified = 0;
7632
7633 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7634 continue;
7635
7636 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
7637 {
7638 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7639
7640 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7641 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7642 continue;
7643
7644 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7645 continue;
7646
7647 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7648 continue;
7649
7650 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7651 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7652 continue;
7653
7654 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7655 {
7656 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7657 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7658 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7659 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7660 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7661 unmapped. */
7662
7663 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7664
7665 bp_modified = 1;
7666 }
7667 }
7668
7669 if (bp_modified)
7670 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7671 }
7672 }
7673
7674 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7675
7676 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7677 catchpoint. A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points
7678 to CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7679
7680 struct fork_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7681 {
7682 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7683 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7684 catchpoint has triggered. */
7685 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7686 };
7687
7688 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7689 catchpoints. */
7690
7691 static int
7692 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7693 {
7694 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7695 }
7696
7697 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7698 catchpoints. */
7699
7700 static int
7701 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7702 {
7703 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7704 }
7705
7706 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7707 catchpoints. */
7708
7709 static int
7710 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7711 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7712 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7713 {
7714 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7715
7716 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7717 return 0;
7718
7719 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7720 return 1;
7721 }
7722
7723 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7724 catchpoints. */
7725
7726 static enum print_stop_action
7727 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
7728 {
7729 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7730 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7731 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7732
7733 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7734 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7735 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7736 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7737 else
7738 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7739 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7740 {
7741 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
7742 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7743 }
7744 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7745 uiout->text (" (forked process ");
7746 uiout->field_int ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7747 uiout->text ("), ");
7748 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7749 }
7750
7751 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7752 catchpoints. */
7753
7754 static void
7755 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7756 {
7757 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7758 struct value_print_options opts;
7759 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7760
7761 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7762
7763 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7764 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7765 readable). */
7766 if (opts.addressprint)
7767 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7768 annotate_field (5);
7769 uiout->text ("fork");
7770 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7771 {
7772 uiout->text (", process ");
7773 uiout->field_int ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7774 uiout->spaces (1);
7775 }
7776
7777 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7778 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "fork");
7779 }
7780
7781 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7782 catchpoints. */
7783
7784 static void
7785 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
7786 {
7787 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
7788 }
7789
7790 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7791 catchpoints. */
7792
7793 static void
7794 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7795 {
7796 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
7797 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7798 }
7799
7800 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7801
7802 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
7803
7804 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7805 catchpoints. */
7806
7807 static int
7808 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7809 {
7810 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7811 }
7812
7813 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7814 catchpoints. */
7815
7816 static int
7817 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7818 {
7819 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7820 }
7821
7822 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7823 catchpoints. */
7824
7825 static int
7826 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7827 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7828 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7829 {
7830 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7831
7832 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
7833 return 0;
7834
7835 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7836 return 1;
7837 }
7838
7839 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7840 catchpoints. */
7841
7842 static enum print_stop_action
7843 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
7844 {
7845 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7846 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7847 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7848
7849 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7850 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7851 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7852 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7853 else
7854 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7855 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7856 {
7857 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
7858 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7859 }
7860 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7861 uiout->text (" (vforked process ");
7862 uiout->field_int ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7863 uiout->text ("), ");
7864 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7865 }
7866
7867 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7868 catchpoints. */
7869
7870 static void
7871 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7872 {
7873 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7874 struct value_print_options opts;
7875 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7876
7877 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7878 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7879 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7880 readable). */
7881 if (opts.addressprint)
7882 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7883 annotate_field (5);
7884 uiout->text ("vfork");
7885 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7886 {
7887 uiout->text (", process ");
7888 uiout->field_int ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7889 uiout->spaces (1);
7890 }
7891
7892 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7893 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "vfork");
7894 }
7895
7896 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7897 catchpoints. */
7898
7899 static void
7900 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
7901 {
7902 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
7903 }
7904
7905 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7906 catchpoints. */
7907
7908 static void
7909 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7910 {
7911 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
7912 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7913 }
7914
7915 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
7916
7917 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
7918
7919 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
7920 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7921 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7922
7923 struct solib_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7924 {
7925 ~solib_catchpoint () override;
7926
7927 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
7928 unsigned char is_load;
7929
7930 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
7931 REGEX is non-NULL. */
7932 char *regex;
7933 std::unique_ptr<compiled_regex> compiled;
7934 };
7935
7936 solib_catchpoint::~solib_catchpoint ()
7937 {
7938 xfree (this->regex);
7939 }
7940
7941 static int
7942 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
7943 {
7944 return 0;
7945 }
7946
7947 static int
7948 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7949 {
7950 return 0;
7951 }
7952
7953 static int
7954 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
7955 const address_space *aspace,
7956 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7957 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7958 {
7959 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7960 struct breakpoint *other;
7961
7962 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
7963 return 1;
7964
7965 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
7966 {
7967 struct bp_location *other_bl;
7968
7969 if (other == bl->owner)
7970 continue;
7971
7972 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
7973 continue;
7974
7975 if (self->pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->pspace)
7976 continue;
7977
7978 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
7979 {
7980 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
7981 return 1;
7982 }
7983 }
7984
7985 return 0;
7986 }
7987
7988 static void
7989 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
7990 {
7991 struct solib_catchpoint *self
7992 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7993
7994 if (self->is_load)
7995 {
7996 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
7997 {
7998 if (!self->regex
7999 || self->compiled->exec (iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8000 return;
8001 }
8002 }
8003 else
8004 {
8005 for (const std::string &iter : current_program_space->deleted_solibs)
8006 {
8007 if (!self->regex
8008 || self->compiled->exec (iter.c_str (), 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8009 return;
8010 }
8011 }
8012
8013 bs->stop = 0;
8014 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8015 }
8016
8017 static enum print_stop_action
8018 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8019 {
8020 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8021 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8022
8023 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8024 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8025 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8026 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8027 else
8028 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8029 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8030 uiout->text ("\n");
8031 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8032 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8033 print_solib_event (1);
8034 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8035 }
8036
8037 static void
8038 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8039 {
8040 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8041 struct value_print_options opts;
8042 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8043
8044 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8045 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8046 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8047 readable). */
8048 if (opts.addressprint)
8049 {
8050 annotate_field (4);
8051 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8052 }
8053
8054 std::string msg;
8055 annotate_field (5);
8056 if (self->is_load)
8057 {
8058 if (self->regex)
8059 msg = string_printf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8060 else
8061 msg = _("load of library");
8062 }
8063 else
8064 {
8065 if (self->regex)
8066 msg = string_printf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8067 else
8068 msg = _("unload of library");
8069 }
8070 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
8071
8072 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8073 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8074 }
8075
8076 static void
8077 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8078 {
8079 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8080
8081 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8082 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8083 }
8084
8085 static void
8086 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8087 {
8088 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8089
8090 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8091 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8092 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8093 if (self->regex)
8094 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8095 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8096 }
8097
8098 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8099
8100 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8101 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8102 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8103 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8104 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8105 created in an enabled state. */
8106
8107 void
8108 add_solib_catchpoint (const char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8109 {
8110 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8111
8112 if (!arg)
8113 arg = "";
8114 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8115
8116 std::unique_ptr<solib_catchpoint> c (new solib_catchpoint ());
8117
8118 if (*arg != '\0')
8119 {
8120 c->compiled.reset (new compiled_regex (arg, REG_NOSUB,
8121 _("Invalid regexp")));
8122 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8123 }
8124
8125 c->is_load = is_load;
8126 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8127 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8128
8129 c->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8130
8131 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8132 }
8133
8134 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8135 "catch unload". */
8136
8137 static void
8138 catch_load_or_unload (const char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8139 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8140 {
8141 int tempflag;
8142 const int enabled = 1;
8143
8144 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8145
8146 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8147 }
8148
8149 static void
8150 catch_load_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8151 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8152 {
8153 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8154 }
8155
8156 static void
8157 catch_unload_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8158 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8159 {
8160 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8161 }
8162
8163 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8164 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8165 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8166 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8167
8168 void
8169 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8170 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8171 const char *cond_string,
8172 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8173 {
8174 symtab_and_line sal;
8175 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8176
8177 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8178
8179 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8180 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8181 }
8182
8183 void
8184 install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll)
8185 {
8186 breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg));
8187 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8188 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8189 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8190 if (!internal)
8191 mention (b);
8192 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
8193
8194 if (update_gll)
8195 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8196 }
8197
8198 static void
8199 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8200 int tempflag, const char *cond_string,
8201 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8202 {
8203 std::unique_ptr<fork_catchpoint> c (new fork_catchpoint ());
8204
8205 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8206
8207 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8208
8209 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8210 }
8211
8212 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8213
8214 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8215 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8216 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8217
8218 struct exec_catchpoint : public breakpoint
8219 {
8220 ~exec_catchpoint () override;
8221
8222 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8223 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8224 triggered. */
8225 char *exec_pathname;
8226 };
8227
8228 /* Exec catchpoint destructor. */
8229
8230 exec_catchpoint::~exec_catchpoint ()
8231 {
8232 xfree (this->exec_pathname);
8233 }
8234
8235 static int
8236 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8237 {
8238 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8239 }
8240
8241 static int
8242 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8243 {
8244 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8245 }
8246
8247 static int
8248 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8249 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8250 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8251 {
8252 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8253
8254 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8255 return 0;
8256
8257 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8258 return 1;
8259 }
8260
8261 static enum print_stop_action
8262 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8263 {
8264 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8265 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8266 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8267
8268 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8269 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8270 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8271 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8272 else
8273 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8274 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8275 {
8276 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8277 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8278 }
8279 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8280 uiout->text (" (exec'd ");
8281 uiout->field_string ("new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8282 uiout->text ("), ");
8283
8284 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8285 }
8286
8287 static void
8288 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8289 {
8290 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8291 struct value_print_options opts;
8292 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8293
8294 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8295
8296 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8297 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8298 is relatively readable). */
8299 if (opts.addressprint)
8300 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8301 annotate_field (5);
8302 uiout->text ("exec");
8303 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8304 {
8305 uiout->text (", program \"");
8306 uiout->field_string ("what", c->exec_pathname);
8307 uiout->text ("\" ");
8308 }
8309
8310 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8311 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "exec");
8312 }
8313
8314 static void
8315 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8316 {
8317 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8318 }
8319
8320 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8321 catchpoints. */
8322
8323 static void
8324 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8325 {
8326 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8327 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8328 }
8329
8330 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8331
8332 static int
8333 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8334 {
8335 int i = 0;
8336 struct breakpoint *b;
8337 struct bp_location *bl;
8338
8339 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8340 {
8341 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8342 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8343 {
8344 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8345 one register. */
8346 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8347 }
8348 }
8349
8350 return i;
8351 }
8352
8353 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8354 watchpoint. */
8355
8356 static int
8357 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8358 {
8359 int i = 0;
8360 struct bp_location *bl;
8361
8362 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8363 return 0;
8364
8365 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8366 {
8367 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8368 one register. */
8369 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8370 }
8371
8372 return i;
8373 }
8374
8375 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8376 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8377 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8378 types _not_ TYPE. */
8379
8380 static int
8381 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8382 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8383 {
8384 int i = 0;
8385 struct breakpoint *b;
8386
8387 *other_type_used = 0;
8388 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8389 {
8390 if (b == except)
8391 continue;
8392 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8393 continue;
8394
8395 if (b->type == type)
8396 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8397 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8398 *other_type_used = 1;
8399 }
8400
8401 return i;
8402 }
8403
8404 void
8405 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8406 {
8407 struct breakpoint *b;
8408
8409 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8410 {
8411 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8412 {
8413 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8414 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8415 }
8416 }
8417 }
8418
8419 void
8420 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8421 {
8422 struct breakpoint *b;
8423
8424 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8425 {
8426 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8427 {
8428 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8429 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8430 }
8431 }
8432 }
8433
8434 void
8435 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8436 {
8437 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8438 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8439 }
8440
8441 void
8442 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8443 {
8444 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8445 breakpoint_re_set ();
8446 }
8447
8448 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8449 locations. */
8450
8451 static struct breakpoint *
8452 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8453 {
8454 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b (new breakpoint ());
8455
8456 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8457 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8458
8459 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8460 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8461
8462 b->thread = thread;
8463 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8464
8465 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
8466 }
8467
8468 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8469 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8470 frame. */
8471
8472 breakpoint_up
8473 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8474 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8475 {
8476 struct breakpoint *b;
8477
8478 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8479 tail-called one. */
8480 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8481
8482 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8483 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8484 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8485 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8486
8487 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
8488
8489 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8490
8491 return breakpoint_up (b);
8492 }
8493
8494 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8495 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8496 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8497
8498 static struct breakpoint *
8499 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8500 enum bptype type,
8501 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8502 int loc_enabled)
8503 {
8504 struct breakpoint *copy;
8505
8506 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8507 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8508 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
8509
8510 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8511 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8512 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8513 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8514 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8515 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8516 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8517 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8518 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8519 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8520 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8521 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8522
8523 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8524 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8525 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8526
8527 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8528 return copy;
8529 }
8530
8531 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8532 ORIG is NULL. */
8533
8534 struct breakpoint *
8535 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8536 {
8537 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8538 if (orig == NULL)
8539 return NULL;
8540
8541 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
8542 }
8543
8544 breakpoint_up
8545 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8546 enum bptype type)
8547 {
8548 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8549
8550 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8551 sal.pc = pc;
8552 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8553 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8554
8555 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8556 }
8557 \f
8558
8559 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8560
8561 static void
8562 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8563 {
8564 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8565 current_uiout->text ("\n");
8566 }
8567 \f
8568
8569 static int bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
8570
8571 static struct bp_location *
8572 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8573 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8574 {
8575 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8576 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8577 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8578
8579 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8580 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8581
8582 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8583 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8584 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8585 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8586 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8587 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8588 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8589 sal->pc, b->type);
8590
8591 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8592 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8593 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
8594 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8595 ;
8596 loc->next = *tmp;
8597 *tmp = loc;
8598
8599 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8600 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8601 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8602 loc->probe.prob = sal->prob;
8603 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
8604 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8605 loc->section = sal->section;
8606 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8607 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8608 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
8609 loc->symbol = sal->symbol;
8610 loc->msymbol = sal->msymbol;
8611 loc->objfile = sal->objfile;
8612
8613 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
8614 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
8615
8616 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8617 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8618 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8619 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8620 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8621 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8622 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8623 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8624 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8625 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8626 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8627 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8628 instruction.) */
8629 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8630 loc->permanent = 1;
8631
8632 return loc;
8633 }
8634 \f
8635
8636 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8637
8638 int
8639 program_breakpoint_here_p (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
8640 {
8641 int len;
8642 CORE_ADDR addr;
8643 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
8644 gdb_byte *target_mem;
8645
8646 addr = address;
8647 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &len);
8648
8649 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
8650 if (bpoint == NULL)
8651 return 0;
8652
8653 target_mem = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
8654
8655 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
8656 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
8657 breakpoints they are permanent. */
8658 scoped_restore restore_memory
8659 = make_scoped_restore_show_memory_breakpoints (0);
8660
8661 if (target_read_memory (address, target_mem, len) == 0
8662 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
8663 return 1;
8664
8665 return 0;
8666 }
8667
8668 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
8669 return 0 otherwise. */
8670
8671 static int
8672 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
8673 {
8674 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
8675
8676 /* If we have a catchpoint or a watchpoint, just return 0. We should not
8677 attempt to read from the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types
8678 point to. program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
8679 memory. */
8680 if (!breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (loc->owner))
8681 return 0;
8682
8683 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
8684 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
8685 return program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
8686 }
8687
8688 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
8689 settings of the dprintf style options. */
8690
8691 static void
8692 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
8693 {
8694 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
8695 char *printf_line = NULL;
8696
8697 if (!dprintf_args)
8698 return;
8699
8700 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8701
8702 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
8703 insist on it. */
8704 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
8705 ++dprintf_args;
8706 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8707
8708 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
8709 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
8710
8711 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
8712 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8713 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
8714 {
8715 if (!dprintf_function)
8716 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
8717
8718 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
8719 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
8720 dprintf_function,
8721 dprintf_channel,
8722 dprintf_args);
8723 else
8724 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
8725 dprintf_function,
8726 dprintf_args);
8727 }
8728 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
8729 {
8730 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
8731 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
8732 else
8733 {
8734 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
8735 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8736 }
8737 }
8738 else
8739 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8740 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
8741
8742 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
8743
8744 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
8745 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line
8746 = new struct command_line (simple_control, printf_line);
8747 breakpoint_set_commands (b, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line,
8748 command_lines_deleter ()));
8749 }
8750
8751 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
8752 current style settings. */
8753
8754 static void
8755 update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty,
8756 struct cmd_list_element *c)
8757 {
8758 struct breakpoint *b;
8759
8760 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8761 {
8762 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
8763 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8764 }
8765 }
8766
8767 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
8768 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
8769 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
8770 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
8771
8772 static void
8773 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8774 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8775 event_location_up &&location,
8776 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8777 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8778 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8779 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8780 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8781 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8782 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8783 int display_canonical)
8784 {
8785 int i;
8786
8787 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
8788 {
8789 int target_resources_ok;
8790
8791 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
8792 target_resources_ok =
8793 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
8794 i + 1, 0);
8795 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
8796 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
8797 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
8798 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
8799 }
8800
8801 gdb_assert (!sals.empty ());
8802
8803 for (const auto &sal : sals)
8804 {
8805 struct bp_location *loc;
8806
8807 if (from_tty)
8808 {
8809 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8810 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8811 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8812
8813 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8814 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
8815 }
8816
8817 if (&sal == &sals[0])
8818 {
8819 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
8820 b->thread = thread;
8821 b->task = task;
8822
8823 b->cond_string = cond_string.release ();
8824 b->extra_string = extra_string.release ();
8825 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
8826 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8827 b->disposition = disposition;
8828
8829 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8830 b->loc->inserted = 1;
8831
8832 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
8833 {
8834 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
8835 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
8836
8837 if (strace_marker_p (b))
8838 {
8839 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
8840 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
8841 const char *p
8842 = &event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())[3];
8843 const char *endp;
8844
8845 p = skip_spaces (p);
8846
8847 endp = skip_to_space (p);
8848
8849 t->static_trace_marker_id.assign (p, endp - p);
8850
8851 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8852 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8853 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8854 }
8855 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
8856 {
8857 t->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
8858
8859 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8860 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8861 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8862 }
8863 else
8864 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
8865 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
8866 }
8867
8868 loc = b->loc;
8869 }
8870 else
8871 {
8872 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
8873 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8874 loc->inserted = 1;
8875 }
8876
8877 if (b->cond_string)
8878 {
8879 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
8880
8881 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
8882 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
8883 if (*arg)
8884 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
8885 }
8886
8887 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
8888 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
8889 if (type == bp_dprintf)
8890 {
8891 if (b->extra_string)
8892 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8893 else
8894 error (_("Format string required"));
8895 }
8896 else if (b->extra_string)
8897 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
8898 }
8899
8900 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
8901 if (location != NULL)
8902 b->location = std::move (location);
8903 else
8904 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
8905 b->filter = filter.release ();
8906 }
8907
8908 static void
8909 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8910 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8911 event_location_up &&location,
8912 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8913 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8914 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8915 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8916 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8917 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8918 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8919 int display_canonical)
8920 {
8921 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type);
8922
8923 init_breakpoint_sal (b.get (), gdbarch,
8924 sals, std::move (location),
8925 std::move (filter),
8926 std::move (cond_string),
8927 std::move (extra_string),
8928 type, disposition,
8929 thread, task, ignore_count,
8930 ops, from_tty,
8931 enabled, internal, flags,
8932 display_canonical);
8933
8934 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
8935 }
8936
8937 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
8938 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
8939 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
8940 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
8941 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
8942 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
8943 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
8944 we take just a single condition string.
8945
8946 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
8947 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
8948 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
8949 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
8950 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
8951
8952 static void
8953 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8954 struct linespec_result *canonical,
8955 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8956 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8957 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8958 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8959 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8960 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
8961 {
8962 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
8963 gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1);
8964
8965 for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals)
8966 {
8967 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
8968 'break', without arguments. */
8969 event_location_up location
8970 = (canonical->location != NULL
8971 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()) : NULL);
8972 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string
8973 (lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL);
8974
8975 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals,
8976 std::move (location),
8977 std::move (filter_string),
8978 std::move (cond_string),
8979 std::move (extra_string),
8980 type, disposition,
8981 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
8982 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
8983 canonical->special_display);
8984 }
8985 }
8986
8987 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
8988 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
8989 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
8990 linespec locations).
8991
8992 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
8993 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
8994
8995 static void
8996 parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location,
8997 struct linespec_result *canonical)
8998 {
8999 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
9000
9001 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9002 {
9003 const char *spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9004
9005 if (spec == NULL)
9006 {
9007 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
9008 breakpoint address. */
9009 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9010 {
9011 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9012 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9013 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9014 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9015 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9016 symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
9017 CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc;
9018
9019 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9020
9021 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9022 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9023 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9024 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9025 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9026 sal.pc = pc;
9027 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9028
9029 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9030 lsal.sals = {sal};
9031 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9032
9033 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
9034 return;
9035 }
9036 else
9037 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9038 }
9039 }
9040
9041 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9042 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9043 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9044 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9045
9046 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9047 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9048 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9049 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9050 {
9051 const char *spec = NULL;
9052
9053 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9054 spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9055
9056 if (!cursal.symtab
9057 || (spec != NULL
9058 && strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL
9059 && spec[1] != '['))
9060 {
9061 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9062 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9063 get_last_displayed_line (),
9064 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9065 return;
9066 }
9067 }
9068
9069 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9070 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9071 }
9072
9073
9074 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9075 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9076
9077 static void
9078 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals)
9079 {
9080 for (auto &sal : sals)
9081 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
9082 }
9083
9084 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9085 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9086 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9087 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9088 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9089 it, etc. */
9090
9091 static void
9092 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9093 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals)
9094 {
9095 for (const auto &sal : sals)
9096 {
9097 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9098
9099 sarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9100 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9101 associated with SAL. */
9102 if (sarch == NULL)
9103 sarch = gdbarch;
9104 std::string msg;
9105 if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg))
9106 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
9107 paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ());
9108 }
9109 }
9110
9111 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9112 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9113 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9114 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9115 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9116 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9117
9118 static void
9119 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9120 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9121 char **rest)
9122 {
9123 *cond_string = NULL;
9124 *thread = -1;
9125 *task = 0;
9126 *rest = NULL;
9127
9128 while (tok && *tok)
9129 {
9130 const char *end_tok;
9131 int toklen;
9132 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9133 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9134
9135 tok = skip_spaces (tok);
9136
9137 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9138 {
9139 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9140 return;
9141 }
9142
9143 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
9144
9145 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9146
9147 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9148 {
9149 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9150 parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9151 cond_end = tok;
9152 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9153 }
9154 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9155 {
9156 const char *tmptok;
9157 struct thread_info *thr;
9158
9159 tok = end_tok + 1;
9160 thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
9161 if (tok == tmptok)
9162 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9163 *thread = thr->global_num;
9164 tok = tmptok;
9165 }
9166 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9167 {
9168 char *tmptok;
9169
9170 tok = end_tok + 1;
9171 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9172 if (tok == tmptok)
9173 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9174 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9175 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9176 tok = tmptok;
9177 }
9178 else if (rest)
9179 {
9180 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9181 return;
9182 }
9183 else
9184 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9185 }
9186 }
9187
9188 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9189
9190 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
9191 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9192 {
9193 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9194 const char *endp;
9195
9196 p = skip_spaces (p);
9197
9198 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9199
9200 std::string marker_str (p, endp - p);
9201
9202 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
9203 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ());
9204 if (markers.empty ())
9205 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"),
9206 marker_str.c_str ());
9207
9208 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
9209 sals.reserve (markers.size ());
9210
9211 for (const static_tracepoint_marker &marker : markers)
9212 {
9213 symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker.address, 0);
9214 sal.pc = marker.address;
9215 sals.push_back (sal);
9216 }
9217
9218 *arg_p = endp;
9219 return sals;
9220 }
9221
9222 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9223
9224 int
9225 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9226 const struct event_location *location,
9227 const char *cond_string,
9228 int thread, const char *extra_string,
9229 int parse_extra,
9230 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9231 int ignore_count,
9232 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9233 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9234 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9235 unsigned flags)
9236 {
9237 struct linespec_result canonical;
9238 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
9239 int pending = 0;
9240 int task = 0;
9241 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9242
9243 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9244
9245 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9246 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9247 extra_string = NULL;
9248
9249 TRY
9250 {
9251 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9252 }
9253 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9254 {
9255 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9256 value. */
9257 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9258 {
9259 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9260 error. */
9261
9262 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9263 throw_exception (e);
9264
9265 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9266
9267 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9268 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9269 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9270 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9271 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9272 return 0;
9273
9274 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9275 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9276 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9277 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9278 pending = 1;
9279 }
9280 else
9281 throw_exception (e);
9282 }
9283 END_CATCH
9284
9285 if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ())
9286 return 0;
9287
9288 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
9289 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
9290 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
9291 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
9292 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
9293
9294 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9295 are ok for the target. */
9296 if (!pending)
9297 {
9298 for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9299 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals);
9300 }
9301
9302 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9303 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9304 {
9305 for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9306 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals);
9307 }
9308
9309 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9310 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9311 breakpoint. */
9312 if (!pending)
9313 {
9314 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy;
9315 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy;
9316
9317 if (parse_extra)
9318 {
9319 char *rest;
9320 char *cond;
9321
9322 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9323
9324 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9325 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9326 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9327 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9328
9329 find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal.sals[0].pc,
9330 &cond, &thread, &task, &rest);
9331 cond_string_copy.reset (cond);
9332 extra_string_copy.reset (rest);
9333 }
9334 else
9335 {
9336 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9337 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9338 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9339
9340 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9341 if (cond_string)
9342 cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string));
9343 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9344 if (extra_string)
9345 extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string));
9346 }
9347
9348 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9349 std::move (cond_string_copy),
9350 std::move (extra_string_copy),
9351 type_wanted,
9352 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9353 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9354 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9355 }
9356 else
9357 {
9358 std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type_wanted);
9359
9360 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9361 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9362
9363 if (parse_extra)
9364 b->cond_string = NULL;
9365 else
9366 {
9367 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9368 b->cond_string = cond_string != NULL ? xstrdup (cond_string) : NULL;
9369 b->thread = thread;
9370 }
9371
9372 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9373 b->extra_string = extra_string != NULL ? xstrdup (extra_string) : NULL;
9374 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9375 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9376 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9377 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9378 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9379 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9380 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9381
9382 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9383 }
9384
9385 if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1)
9386 {
9387 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9388 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9389 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9390 }
9391
9392 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
9393 breakpoint. */
9394 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
9395
9396 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
9397 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9398
9399 return 1;
9400 }
9401
9402 /* Set a breakpoint.
9403 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9404 condition, and thread.
9405 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9406 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9407 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9408
9409 static void
9410 break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9411 {
9412 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9413 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9414 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9415 : bp_breakpoint);
9416 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
9417
9418 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9419
9420 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
9421 if (location != NULL
9422 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
9423 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9424 else
9425 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9426
9427 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9428 location.get (),
9429 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9430 tempflag, type_wanted,
9431 0 /* Ignore count */,
9432 pending_break_support,
9433 ops,
9434 from_tty,
9435 1 /* enabled */,
9436 0 /* internal */,
9437 0);
9438 }
9439
9440 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9441
9442 void
9443 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9444 {
9445 CORE_ADDR pc;
9446
9447 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9448 {
9449 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9450 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9451 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
9452 sal->pc = pc;
9453
9454 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9455 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9456 if (sal->explicit_line)
9457 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9458 }
9459
9460 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9461 {
9462 const struct blockvector *bv;
9463 const struct block *b;
9464 struct symbol *sym;
9465
9466 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
9467 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
9468 if (bv != NULL)
9469 {
9470 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9471 if (sym != NULL)
9472 {
9473 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9474 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
9475 sym);
9476 }
9477 else
9478 {
9479 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9480 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9481 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9482 happen in assembly source). */
9483
9484 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
9485 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9486
9487 bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9488 if (msym.minsym)
9489 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
9490 }
9491 }
9492 }
9493 }
9494
9495 void
9496 break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9497 {
9498 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9499 }
9500
9501 void
9502 tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9503 {
9504 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9505 }
9506
9507 static void
9508 hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9509 {
9510 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9511 }
9512
9513 static void
9514 thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9515 {
9516 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9517 }
9518
9519 static void
9520 stop_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9521 {
9522 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9523 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9524 stop at <line>\n"));
9525 }
9526
9527 static void
9528 stopin_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9529 {
9530 int badInput = 0;
9531
9532 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
9533 badInput = 1;
9534 else if (*arg != '*')
9535 {
9536 const char *argptr = arg;
9537 int hasColon = 0;
9538
9539 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9540 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9541 function/method name. */
9542 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9543 {
9544 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9545 argptr++;
9546 }
9547
9548 if (hasColon)
9549 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
9550 else
9551 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
9552 }
9553
9554 if (badInput)
9555 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
9556 else
9557 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9558 }
9559
9560 static void
9561 stopat_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9562 {
9563 int badInput = 0;
9564
9565 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
9566 badInput = 1;
9567 else
9568 {
9569 const char *argptr = arg;
9570 int hasColon = 0;
9571
9572 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
9573 it is probably a line number. */
9574 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9575 {
9576 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9577 argptr++;
9578 }
9579
9580 if (hasColon)
9581 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
9582 else
9583 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
9584 }
9585
9586 if (badInput)
9587 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at LINE\n"));
9588 else
9589 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9590 }
9591
9592 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
9593 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
9594 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
9595 line. */
9596
9597 static void
9598 dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9599 {
9600 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9601
9602 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
9603 the next character must be ','. */
9604 if (arg != NULL)
9605 {
9606 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
9607 error (_("Format string required"));
9608 else
9609 {
9610 /* Skip the comma. */
9611 ++arg;
9612 }
9613 }
9614
9615 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9616 location.get (),
9617 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9618 0, bp_dprintf,
9619 0 /* Ignore count */,
9620 pending_break_support,
9621 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
9622 from_tty,
9623 1 /* enabled */,
9624 0 /* internal */,
9625 0);
9626 }
9627
9628 static void
9629 agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9630 {
9631 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
9632 }
9633
9634 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
9635 ranged breakpoints. */
9636
9637 static int
9638 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
9639 const address_space *aspace,
9640 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
9641 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
9642 {
9643 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
9644 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
9645 return 0;
9646
9647 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
9648 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
9649 }
9650
9651 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9652 ranged breakpoints. */
9653
9654 static int
9655 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9656 {
9657 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9658 }
9659
9660 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9661 ranged breakpoints. */
9662
9663 static enum print_stop_action
9664 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
9665 {
9666 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9667 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9668 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9669
9670 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9671
9672 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9673 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9674
9675 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
9676
9677 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
9678
9679 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
9680 uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
9681 else
9682 uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint ");
9683 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9684 {
9685 uiout->field_string ("reason",
9686 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
9687 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
9688 }
9689 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
9690 uiout->text (", ");
9691
9692 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
9693 }
9694
9695 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
9696 ranged breakpoints. */
9697
9698 static void
9699 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9700 struct bp_location **last_loc)
9701 {
9702 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9703 struct value_print_options opts;
9704 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9705
9706 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9707 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9708
9709 get_user_print_options (&opts);
9710
9711 if (opts.addressprint)
9712 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
9713 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
9714 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
9715 annotate_field (5);
9716 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
9717 *last_loc = bl;
9718 }
9719
9720 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
9721 ranged breakpoints. */
9722
9723 static void
9724 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
9725 struct ui_out *uiout)
9726 {
9727 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
9728 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9729 string_file stb;
9730
9731 gdb_assert (bl);
9732
9733 address_start = bl->address;
9734 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
9735
9736 uiout->text ("\taddress range: ");
9737 stb.printf ("[%s, %s]",
9738 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
9739 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
9740 uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb);
9741 uiout->text ("\n");
9742 }
9743
9744 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
9745 ranged breakpoints. */
9746
9747 static void
9748 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9749 {
9750 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9751 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9752
9753 gdb_assert (bl);
9754 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9755
9756 uiout->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
9757 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
9758 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
9759 }
9760
9761 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9762 ranged breakpoints. */
9763
9764 static void
9765 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
9766 {
9767 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
9768 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
9769 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end.get ()));
9770 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
9771 }
9772
9773 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
9774
9775 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
9776
9777 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
9778 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
9779 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
9780 last instruction of the given line. */
9781
9782 static CORE_ADDR
9783 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
9784 {
9785 CORE_ADDR end;
9786
9787 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
9788 find the address of the end of the given location. */
9789 if (sal.explicit_pc)
9790 end = sal.pc;
9791 else
9792 {
9793 int ret;
9794 CORE_ADDR start;
9795
9796 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
9797 if (!ret)
9798 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9799
9800 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
9801 end--;
9802 }
9803
9804 return end;
9805 }
9806
9807 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
9808
9809 static void
9810 break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9811 {
9812 const char *arg_start;
9813 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
9814 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
9815 CORE_ADDR end;
9816 struct breakpoint *b;
9817
9818 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
9819 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
9820 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
9821
9822 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9823 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9824 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9825 bp_count, 0);
9826 if (can_use_bp < 0)
9827 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9828
9829 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9830 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
9831 error(_("No address range specified."));
9832
9833 arg_start = arg;
9834 event_location_up start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9835 current_language);
9836 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location.get (), &canonical_start);
9837
9838 if (arg[0] != ',')
9839 error (_("Too few arguments."));
9840 else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ())
9841 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
9842
9843 const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0];
9844
9845 if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1
9846 || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1)
9847 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9848
9849 const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0];
9850 std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
9851
9852 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
9853 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9854
9855 /* Parse the end location. */
9856
9857 arg_start = arg;
9858
9859 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
9860 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
9861 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
9862 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
9863 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
9864 event_location_up end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9865 current_language);
9866 decode_line_full (end_location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9867 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
9868 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
9869
9870 if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ())
9871 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9872
9873 const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0];
9874 if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1
9875 || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1)
9876 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9877
9878 const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0];
9879
9880 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
9881 if (sal_start.pc > end)
9882 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
9883
9884 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
9885 if (length < 0)
9886 /* Length overflowed. */
9887 error (_("Address range too large."));
9888 else if (length == 1)
9889 {
9890 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
9891 the `hbreak' command. */
9892 hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1);
9893
9894 return;
9895 }
9896
9897 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
9898 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
9899 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
9900 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
9901 b->number = breakpoint_count;
9902 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9903 b->location = std::move (start_location);
9904 b->location_range_end = std::move (end_location);
9905 b->loc->length = length;
9906
9907 mention (b);
9908 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
9909 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9910 }
9911
9912 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
9913 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
9914 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
9915 zero. */
9916
9917 static int
9918 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
9919 {
9920 int i = exp->nelts;
9921
9922 while (i > 0)
9923 {
9924 int oplenp, argsp;
9925
9926 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
9927 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
9928 i -= oplenp;
9929
9930 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
9931 {
9932 case BINOP_ADD:
9933 case BINOP_SUB:
9934 case BINOP_MUL:
9935 case BINOP_DIV:
9936 case BINOP_REM:
9937 case BINOP_MOD:
9938 case BINOP_LSH:
9939 case BINOP_RSH:
9940 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
9941 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
9942 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
9943 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
9944 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
9945 case BINOP_EQUAL:
9946 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
9947 case BINOP_LESS:
9948 case BINOP_GTR:
9949 case BINOP_LEQ:
9950 case BINOP_GEQ:
9951 case BINOP_REPEAT:
9952 case BINOP_COMMA:
9953 case BINOP_EXP:
9954 case BINOP_MIN:
9955 case BINOP_MAX:
9956 case BINOP_INTDIV:
9957 case BINOP_CONCAT:
9958 case TERNOP_COND:
9959 case TERNOP_SLICE:
9960
9961 case OP_LONG:
9962 case OP_FLOAT:
9963 case OP_LAST:
9964 case OP_COMPLEX:
9965 case OP_STRING:
9966 case OP_ARRAY:
9967 case OP_TYPE:
9968 case OP_TYPEOF:
9969 case OP_DECLTYPE:
9970 case OP_TYPEID:
9971 case OP_NAME:
9972 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
9973
9974 case UNOP_NEG:
9975 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
9976 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
9977 case UNOP_ADDR:
9978 case UNOP_HIGH:
9979 case UNOP_CAST:
9980
9981 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
9982 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
9983 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
9984 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
9985 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
9986 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
9987 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
9988
9989 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
9990 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
9991 ADDR is. */
9992 break;
9993
9994 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
9995 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
9996
9997 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
9998 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
9999 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
10000 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
10001
10002 We also have to check for function symbols because they
10003 are always constant. */
10004 {
10005 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
10006
10007 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
10008 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
10009 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
10010 return 0;
10011 break;
10012 }
10013
10014 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
10015 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
10016 then it is not a constant. */
10017 default:
10018 return 0;
10019 }
10020 }
10021
10022 return 1;
10023 }
10024
10025 /* Watchpoint destructor. */
10026
10027 watchpoint::~watchpoint ()
10028 {
10029 xfree (this->exp_string);
10030 xfree (this->exp_string_reparse);
10031 }
10032
10033 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10034
10035 static void
10036 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10037 {
10038 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10039
10040 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10041 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10042
10043 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10044 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10045 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10046 are loaded and unloaded.
10047
10048 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10049 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10050 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10051 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10052 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10053 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10054
10055 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10056 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10057 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10058 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10059
10060 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10061 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10062
10063 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10064 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10065 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10066 }
10067
10068 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10069
10070 static int
10071 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10072 {
10073 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10074 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10075
10076 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10077 w->cond_exp.get ());
10078 }
10079
10080 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10081
10082 static int
10083 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10084 {
10085 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10086 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10087
10088 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10089 w->cond_exp.get ());
10090 }
10091
10092 static int
10093 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10094 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10095 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10096 {
10097 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10098 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10099
10100 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10101 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10102 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10103 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10104 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10105 (did not match the data address). */
10106 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10107 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10108 return 0;
10109
10110 return 1;
10111 }
10112
10113 static void
10114 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10115 {
10116 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10117
10118 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10119 }
10120
10121 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10122 hardware watchpoints. */
10123
10124 static int
10125 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10126 {
10127 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10128 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10129
10130 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10131 }
10132
10133 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10134 hardware watchpoints. */
10135
10136 static int
10137 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10138 {
10139 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10140 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10141 }
10142
10143 static enum print_stop_action
10144 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10145 {
10146 struct breakpoint *b;
10147 enum print_stop_action result;
10148 struct watchpoint *w;
10149 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10150
10151 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10152
10153 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10154 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10155
10156 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10157 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10158
10159 string_file stb;
10160
10161 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter;
10162 switch (b->type)
10163 {
10164 case bp_watchpoint:
10165 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10166 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10167 uiout->field_string
10168 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10169 mention (b);
10170 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10171 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10172 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10173 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10174 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10175 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10176 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10177 uiout->text ("\n");
10178 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10179 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10180 break;
10181
10182 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10183 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10184 uiout->field_string
10185 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10186 mention (b);
10187 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10188 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10189 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10190 uiout->field_stream ("value", stb);
10191 uiout->text ("\n");
10192 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10193 break;
10194
10195 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10196 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10197 {
10198 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10199 uiout->field_string
10200 ("reason",
10201 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10202 mention (b);
10203 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10204 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10205 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10206 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10207 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10208 }
10209 else
10210 {
10211 mention (b);
10212 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10213 uiout->field_string
10214 ("reason",
10215 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10216 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10217 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10218 }
10219 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10220 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10221 uiout->text ("\n");
10222 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10223 break;
10224 default:
10225 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10226 }
10227
10228 return result;
10229 }
10230
10231 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10232 watchpoints. */
10233
10234 static void
10235 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10236 {
10237 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10238 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10239 const char *tuple_name;
10240
10241 switch (b->type)
10242 {
10243 case bp_watchpoint:
10244 uiout->text ("Watchpoint ");
10245 tuple_name = "wpt";
10246 break;
10247 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10248 uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint ");
10249 tuple_name = "wpt";
10250 break;
10251 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10252 uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint ");
10253 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10254 break;
10255 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10256 uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10257 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10258 break;
10259 default:
10260 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10261 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10262 }
10263
10264 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10265 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10266 uiout->text (": ");
10267 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10268 }
10269
10270 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10271 watchpoints. */
10272
10273 static void
10274 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10275 {
10276 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10277
10278 switch (b->type)
10279 {
10280 case bp_watchpoint:
10281 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10282 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10283 break;
10284 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10285 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10286 break;
10287 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10288 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10289 break;
10290 default:
10291 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10292 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10293 }
10294
10295 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10296 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10297 }
10298
10299 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10300 watchpoints. */
10301
10302 static int
10303 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10304 {
10305 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10306 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10307 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10308 return 0;
10309
10310 return 1;
10311 }
10312
10313 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10314
10315 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10316
10317 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10318 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10319
10320 static int
10321 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10322 {
10323 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10324
10325 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10326 bl->watchpoint_type);
10327 }
10328
10329 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10330 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10331
10332 static int
10333 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10334 {
10335 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10336
10337 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10338 bl->watchpoint_type);
10339 }
10340
10341 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10342 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10343
10344 static int
10345 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10346 {
10347 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10348
10349 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10350 }
10351
10352 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10353 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10354
10355 static int
10356 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10357 {
10358 return 0;
10359 }
10360
10361 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10362 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10363
10364 static enum print_stop_action
10365 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10366 {
10367 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10368 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10369
10370 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10371 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10372
10373 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10374 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10375
10376 switch (b->type)
10377 {
10378 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10379 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10380 uiout->field_string
10381 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10382 break;
10383
10384 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10385 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10386 uiout->field_string
10387 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10388 break;
10389
10390 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10391 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10392 uiout->field_string
10393 ("reason",
10394 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10395 break;
10396 default:
10397 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10398 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10399 }
10400
10401 mention (b);
10402 uiout->text (_("\n\
10403 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10404 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10405 uiout->text ("\n");
10406
10407 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10408 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10409 }
10410
10411 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10412 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10413
10414 static void
10415 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10416 struct ui_out *uiout)
10417 {
10418 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10419
10420 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10421 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10422
10423 uiout->text ("\tmask ");
10424 uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10425 uiout->text ("\n");
10426 }
10427
10428 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10429 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10430
10431 static void
10432 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10433 {
10434 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10435 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10436 const char *tuple_name;
10437
10438 switch (b->type)
10439 {
10440 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10441 uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10442 tuple_name = "wpt";
10443 break;
10444 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10445 uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10446 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10447 break;
10448 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10449 uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10450 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10451 break;
10452 default:
10453 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10454 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10455 }
10456
10457 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10458 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10459 uiout->text (": ");
10460 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10461 }
10462
10463 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10464 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10465
10466 static void
10467 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10468 {
10469 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10470 char tmp[40];
10471
10472 switch (b->type)
10473 {
10474 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10475 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10476 break;
10477 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10478 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10479 break;
10480 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10481 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10482 break;
10483 default:
10484 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10485 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10486 }
10487
10488 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
10489 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
10490 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10491 }
10492
10493 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10494
10495 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10496
10497 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10498
10499 static int
10500 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10501 {
10502 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10503 }
10504
10505 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10506 hw_read: watch read,
10507 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10508 static void
10509 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
10510 int just_location, int internal)
10511 {
10512 struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
10513 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
10514 struct value *result;
10515 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
10516 const char *exp_start = NULL;
10517 const char *exp_end = NULL;
10518 const char *tok, *end_tok;
10519 int toklen = -1;
10520 const char *cond_start = NULL;
10521 const char *cond_end = NULL;
10522 enum bptype bp_type;
10523 int thread = -1;
10524 int pc = 0;
10525 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
10526 the hardware watchpoint. */
10527 int use_mask = 0;
10528 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
10529
10530 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
10531 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
10532 {
10533 const char *value_start;
10534
10535 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
10536
10537 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
10538 of the arguments string. */
10539 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
10540 {
10541 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
10542 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10543 tok--;
10544
10545 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
10546 This is the value of the parameter. */
10547 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10548 tok--;
10549 value_start = tok + 1;
10550
10551 /* Skip whitespace. */
10552 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10553 tok--;
10554
10555 end_tok = tok;
10556
10557 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
10558 This is the parameter itself. */
10559 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10560 tok--;
10561 tok++;
10562 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
10563
10564 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
10565 {
10566 struct thread_info *thr;
10567 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
10568 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
10569 only in a specific thread. */
10570 const char *endp;
10571
10572 if (thread != -1)
10573 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
10574
10575 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
10576 thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
10577
10578 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
10579 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
10580 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
10581
10582 thread = thr->global_num;
10583 }
10584 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
10585 {
10586 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
10587 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
10588 facility. */
10589 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
10590
10591 if (use_mask)
10592 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
10593
10594 use_mask = just_location = 1;
10595
10596 mark = value_mark ();
10597 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
10598 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
10599 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10600 }
10601 else
10602 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
10603 break;
10604
10605 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
10606 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
10607 exp_end = tok;
10608 }
10609 }
10610 else
10611 exp_end = arg;
10612
10613 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
10614 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
10615 ARG. */
10616 innermost_block.reset ();
10617 std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg);
10618 exp_start = arg = expression.c_str ();
10619 expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
10620 exp_end = arg;
10621 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
10622 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
10623 prettier. */
10624 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
10625 --exp_end;
10626
10627 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
10628 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ()))
10629 {
10630 int len;
10631
10632 len = exp_end - exp_start;
10633 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
10634 len--;
10635 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
10636 }
10637
10638 exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
10639 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
10640 struct value *val_as_value = nullptr;
10641 fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), &pc, &val_as_value, &result, NULL,
10642 just_location);
10643
10644 if (val_as_value != NULL && just_location)
10645 {
10646 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val_as_value);
10647 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val_as_value);
10648 }
10649
10650 value_ref_ptr val;
10651 if (just_location)
10652 {
10653 int ret;
10654
10655 exp_valid_block = NULL;
10656 val = release_value (value_addr (result));
10657 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10658
10659 if (use_mask)
10660 {
10661 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val.get ()),
10662 mask);
10663 if (ret == -1)
10664 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
10665 else if (ret == -2)
10666 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
10667 }
10668 }
10669 else if (val_as_value != NULL)
10670 val = release_value (val_as_value);
10671
10672 tok = skip_spaces (arg);
10673 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
10674
10675 toklen = end_tok - tok;
10676 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
10677 {
10678 innermost_block.reset ();
10679 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
10680 parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0);
10681
10682 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
10683 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
10684 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
10685
10686 cond_end = tok;
10687 }
10688 if (*tok)
10689 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
10690
10691 frame_info *wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
10692
10693 /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates
10694 'wp_frame'. */
10695 frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame);
10696
10697 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
10698 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
10699 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
10700 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
10701 if (exp_valid_block != NULL && wp_frame != NULL)
10702 {
10703 frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame);
10704
10705 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
10706 {
10707 gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame);
10708 CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame);
10709
10710 scope_breakpoint
10711 = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc,
10712 bp_watchpoint_scope,
10713 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
10714
10715 /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */
10716 wp_frame = NULL;
10717
10718 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10719
10720 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
10721 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
10722
10723 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
10724 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id;
10725
10726 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
10727 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch = caller_arch;
10728 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address = caller_pc;
10729 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
10730 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
10731 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
10732 scope_breakpoint->type);
10733 }
10734 }
10735
10736 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
10737 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
10738 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
10739 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
10740
10741 if (accessflag == hw_read)
10742 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
10743 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
10744 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
10745 else
10746 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10747
10748 std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w (new watchpoint ());
10749
10750 if (use_mask)
10751 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10752 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10753 else
10754 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10755 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10756 w->thread = thread;
10757 w->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10758 w->pspace = current_program_space;
10759 w->exp = std::move (exp);
10760 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
10761 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
10762 if (just_location)
10763 {
10764 struct type *t = value_type (val.get ());
10765 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val.get ());
10766
10767 w->exp_string_reparse
10768 = current_language->la_watch_location_expression (t, addr).release ();
10769
10770 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
10771 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
10772 }
10773 else
10774 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
10775
10776 if (use_mask)
10777 {
10778 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
10779 }
10780 else
10781 {
10782 w->val = val;
10783 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
10784 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
10785 w->val_valid = 1;
10786 }
10787
10788 if (cond_start)
10789 w->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
10790 else
10791 w->cond_string = 0;
10792
10793 if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame))
10794 {
10795 w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame;
10796 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
10797 }
10798 else
10799 {
10800 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
10801 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
10802 }
10803
10804 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
10805 {
10806 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
10807 need to act on them together. */
10808 w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
10809 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get ();
10810 }
10811
10812 if (!just_location)
10813 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10814
10815 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
10816 that should be inserted. */
10817 update_watchpoint (w.get (), 1);
10818
10819 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1);
10820 }
10821
10822 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
10823 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
10824
10825 static int
10826 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals)
10827 {
10828 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
10829
10830 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
10831 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
10832 return 0;
10833
10834 gdb_assert (!vals.empty ());
10835 struct value *head = vals[0].get ();
10836
10837 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
10838 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
10839 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
10840 hardware watchpoint.
10841
10842 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
10843 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
10844 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
10845 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
10846 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
10847 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
10848 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
10849 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
10850 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
10851
10852 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
10853 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
10854 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
10855 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
10856 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : vals)
10857 {
10858 struct value *v = iter.get ();
10859
10860 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
10861 {
10862 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
10863 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
10864 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
10865 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
10866 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
10867 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
10868 ;
10869 else
10870 {
10871 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
10872 it with hardware watchpoints. */
10873 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
10874
10875 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
10876 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
10877 middle of some value chain. */
10878 if (v == head
10879 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10880 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
10881 {
10882 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
10883 int len;
10884 int num_regs;
10885
10886 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
10887 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
10888 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
10889
10890 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
10891 if (!num_regs)
10892 return 0;
10893 else
10894 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
10895 }
10896 }
10897 }
10898 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
10899 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
10900 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
10901 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
10902 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
10903 }
10904
10905 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
10906 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
10907 return found_memory_cnt;
10908 }
10909
10910 void
10911 watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10912 {
10913 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
10914 }
10915
10916 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
10917 calls watch_command_1. */
10918
10919 static void
10920 watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
10921 {
10922 int just_location = 0;
10923
10924 if (arg
10925 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
10926 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
10927 {
10928 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10929 just_location = 1;
10930 }
10931
10932 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
10933 }
10934
10935 static void
10936 watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10937 {
10938 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
10939 }
10940
10941 void
10942 rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10943 {
10944 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
10945 }
10946
10947 static void
10948 rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10949 {
10950 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
10951 }
10952
10953 void
10954 awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10955 {
10956 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
10957 }
10958
10959 static void
10960 awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10961 {
10962 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
10963 }
10964 \f
10965
10966 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
10967 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
10968 breakpoints. */
10969
10970 struct until_break_fsm
10971 {
10972 /* The base class. */
10973 struct thread_fsm thread_fsm;
10974
10975 /* The thread that as current when the command was executed. */
10976 int thread;
10977
10978 /* The breakpoint set at the destination location. */
10979 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint;
10980
10981 /* Breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame. May be
10982 NULL. */
10983 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint;
10984 };
10985
10986 static void until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
10987 struct thread_info *thread);
10988 static int until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
10989 struct thread_info *thread);
10990 static enum async_reply_reason
10991 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self);
10992
10993 /* until_break_fsm's vtable. */
10994
10995 static struct thread_fsm_ops until_break_fsm_ops =
10996 {
10997 NULL, /* dtor */
10998 until_break_fsm_clean_up,
10999 until_break_fsm_should_stop,
11000 NULL, /* return_value */
11001 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason,
11002 };
11003
11004 /* Allocate a new until_break_command_fsm. */
11005
11006 static struct until_break_fsm *
11007 new_until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
11008 breakpoint_up &&location_breakpoint,
11009 breakpoint_up &&caller_breakpoint)
11010 {
11011 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11012
11013 sm = XCNEW (struct until_break_fsm);
11014 thread_fsm_ctor (&sm->thread_fsm, &until_break_fsm_ops, cmd_interp);
11015
11016 sm->thread = thread;
11017 sm->location_breakpoint = location_breakpoint.release ();
11018 sm->caller_breakpoint = caller_breakpoint.release ();
11019
11020 return sm;
11021 }
11022
11023 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
11024 until(location)/advance commands. */
11025
11026 static int
11027 until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
11028 struct thread_info *tp)
11029 {
11030 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11031
11032 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11033 sm->location_breakpoint) != NULL
11034 || (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL
11035 && bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11036 sm->caller_breakpoint) != NULL))
11037 thread_fsm_set_finished (self);
11038
11039 return 1;
11040 }
11041
11042 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
11043 until(location)/advance commands. */
11044
11045 static void
11046 until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
11047 struct thread_info *thread)
11048 {
11049 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11050
11051 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
11052 if (sm->location_breakpoint != NULL)
11053 {
11054 delete_breakpoint (sm->location_breakpoint);
11055 sm->location_breakpoint = NULL;
11056 }
11057 if (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL)
11058 {
11059 delete_breakpoint (sm->caller_breakpoint);
11060 sm->caller_breakpoint = NULL;
11061 }
11062 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (sm->thread);
11063 }
11064
11065 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
11066 until(location)/advance commands. */
11067
11068 static enum async_reply_reason
11069 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self)
11070 {
11071 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
11072 }
11073
11074 void
11075 until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11076 {
11077 struct frame_info *frame;
11078 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11079 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11080 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11081 struct cleanup *old_chain;
11082 int thread;
11083 struct thread_info *tp;
11084 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11085
11086 clear_proceed_status (0);
11087
11088 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11089 this function. */
11090
11091 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
11092
11093 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals
11094 = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
11095 ? decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
11096 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11097 get_last_displayed_line ())
11098 : decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11099 NULL, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0));
11100
11101 if (sals.size () != 1)
11102 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11103
11104 symtab_and_line &sal = sals[0];
11105
11106 if (*arg)
11107 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11108
11109 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11110
11111 tp = inferior_thread ();
11112 thread = tp->global_num;
11113
11114 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11115
11116 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11117 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11118 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11119 that. */
11120
11121 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11122 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11123 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11124 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11125
11126 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11127 one. */
11128
11129 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint;
11130 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11131 {
11132 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11133 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
11134
11135 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11136 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11137 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11138 caller_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch,
11139 sal2,
11140 caller_frame_id,
11141 bp_until);
11142
11143 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11144 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
11145 }
11146
11147 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11148 frame = NULL;
11149
11150 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint;
11151 if (anywhere)
11152 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11153 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11154 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11155 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11156 else
11157 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11158 only at the very same frame. */
11159 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11160 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11161
11162 sm = new_until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
11163 std::move (location_breakpoint),
11164 std::move (caller_breakpoint));
11165 tp->thread_fsm = &sm->thread_fsm;
11166
11167 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11168
11169 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11170 }
11171
11172 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11173 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11174
11175 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11176 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11177 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11178 if clause in the arg string. */
11179
11180 const char *
11181 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (const char **arg)
11182 {
11183 const char *cond_string;
11184
11185 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11186 return NULL;
11187
11188 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11189 (*arg) += 2;
11190
11191 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11192 condition string. */
11193 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11194 cond_string = *arg;
11195
11196 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11197 string. */
11198 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11199
11200 return cond_string;
11201 }
11202
11203 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11204 process start/exit, etc. */
11205
11206 typedef enum
11207 {
11208 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11209 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11210 }
11211 catch_fork_kind;
11212
11213 static void
11214 catch_fork_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11215 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11216 {
11217 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11218 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11219 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11220 int tempflag;
11221
11222 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11223 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11224 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11225
11226 if (!arg)
11227 arg = "";
11228 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11229
11230 /* The allowed syntax is:
11231 catch [v]fork
11232 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11233
11234 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11235 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11236
11237 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11238 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11239
11240 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11241 and enable reporting of such events. */
11242 switch (fork_kind)
11243 {
11244 case catch_fork_temporary:
11245 case catch_fork_permanent:
11246 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11247 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11248 break;
11249 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11250 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11251 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11252 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11253 break;
11254 default:
11255 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11256 break;
11257 }
11258 }
11259
11260 static void
11261 catch_exec_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11262 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11263 {
11264 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11265 int tempflag;
11266 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11267
11268 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11269
11270 if (!arg)
11271 arg = "";
11272 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11273
11274 /* The allowed syntax is:
11275 catch exec
11276 catch exec if <cond>
11277
11278 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11279 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11280
11281 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11282 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11283
11284 std::unique_ptr<exec_catchpoint> c (new exec_catchpoint ());
11285 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11286 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11287 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11288
11289 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
11290 }
11291
11292 void
11293 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11294 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11295 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11296 const char *addr_string,
11297 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11298 int tempflag,
11299 int enabled,
11300 int from_tty)
11301 {
11302 if (from_tty)
11303 {
11304 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11305 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11306 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11307
11308 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11309 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11310 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11311 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11312 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11313 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11314 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11315 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11316 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11317 enough for now, though. */
11318 }
11319
11320 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
11321
11322 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11323 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11324 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11325 language_def (language_ada));
11326 b->language = language_ada;
11327 }
11328
11329 static void
11330 catch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11331 {
11332 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11333 }
11334 \f
11335
11336 static void
11337 tcatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11338 {
11339 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11340 }
11341
11342 /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */
11343
11344 static int
11345 compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11346 {
11347 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a;
11348 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b;
11349
11350 if (a->number < b->number)
11351 return -1;
11352 else if (a->number > b->number)
11353 return 1;
11354
11355 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11356 the number 0. */
11357 if (ua < ub)
11358 return -1;
11359 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
11360 }
11361
11362 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11363
11364 static void
11365 clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11366 {
11367 struct breakpoint *b;
11368 int default_match;
11369
11370 std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals;
11371 symtab_and_line last_sal;
11372 gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals;
11373 if (arg)
11374 {
11375 decoded_sals
11376 = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
11377 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11378 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
11379 default_match = 0;
11380 sals = decoded_sals;
11381 }
11382 else
11383 {
11384 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11385 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11386 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11387 last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
11388 if (last_sal.symtab == 0)
11389 error (_("No source file specified."));
11390
11391 default_match = 1;
11392 sals = last_sal;
11393 }
11394
11395 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11396 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11397 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11398 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11399
11400 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11401 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11402 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11403 due to optimization, all in one block.
11404
11405 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11406 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11407 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11408 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11409 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11410 to support that. */
11411
11412 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11413 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11414 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11415 breakpoint. */
11416
11417 std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found;
11418 for (const auto &sal : sals)
11419 {
11420 const char *sal_fullname;
11421
11422 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11423 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11424 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11425 or at default pc.
11426
11427 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11428
11429 0 1 pc
11430 1 1 pc _and_ line
11431 0 0 line
11432 1 0 <can't happen> */
11433
11434 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
11435 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
11436
11437 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11438 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11439 {
11440 int match = 0;
11441 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11442 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
11443 {
11444 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
11445 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
11446 {
11447 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11448 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11449 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
11450 && sal.pc
11451 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
11452 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
11453 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
11454 || loc->section == sal.section));
11455 int line_match = 0;
11456
11457 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
11458 && loc->symtab != NULL
11459 && sal_fullname != NULL
11460 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
11461 && loc->line_number == sal.line
11462 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
11463 sal_fullname) == 0)
11464 line_match = 1;
11465
11466 if (pc_match || line_match)
11467 {
11468 match = 1;
11469 break;
11470 }
11471 }
11472 }
11473
11474 if (match)
11475 found.push_back (b);
11476 }
11477 }
11478
11479 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
11480 if (found.empty ())
11481 {
11482 if (arg)
11483 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
11484 else
11485 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
11486 }
11487
11488 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
11489 std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (),
11490 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11491 {
11492 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) < 0;
11493 });
11494 found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (),
11495 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11496 {
11497 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) == 0;
11498 }),
11499 found.end ());
11500
11501 if (found.size () > 1)
11502 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
11503 if (from_tty)
11504 {
11505 if (found.size () == 1)
11506 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
11507 else
11508 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
11509 }
11510
11511 for (breakpoint *iter : found)
11512 {
11513 if (from_tty)
11514 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", iter->number);
11515 delete_breakpoint (iter);
11516 }
11517 if (from_tty)
11518 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
11519 }
11520 \f
11521 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11522 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11523 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11524
11525 void
11526 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
11527 {
11528 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
11529
11530 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
11531 if (bs->breakpoint_at
11532 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
11533 && bs->stop)
11534 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
11535
11536 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
11537 {
11538 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
11539 delete_breakpoint (b);
11540 }
11541 }
11542
11543 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
11544 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
11545 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
11546 secondarily by ordering first permanent elements and
11547 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
11548 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
11549
11550 static int
11551 bp_locations_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
11552 {
11553 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
11554 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
11555
11556 if (a->address != b->address)
11557 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
11558
11559 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
11560 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
11561 grouped. */
11562
11563 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
11564 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
11565 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
11566
11567 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
11568 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
11569 return (a->permanent < b->permanent) - (a->permanent > b->permanent);
11570
11571 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
11572 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
11573 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
11574
11575 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
11576 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
11577 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
11578
11579 return (a > b) - (a < b);
11580 }
11581
11582 /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and
11583 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
11584 content of the bp_locations array. */
11585
11586 static void
11587 bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void)
11588 {
11589 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
11590
11591 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
11592 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
11593
11594 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
11595 {
11596 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
11597
11598 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
11599 continue;
11600
11601 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
11602 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
11603
11604 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
11605 addr = bl->address - start;
11606 if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
11607 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
11608
11609 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
11610
11611 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
11612 addr = end - bl->address;
11613 if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max)
11614 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
11615 }
11616 }
11617
11618 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
11619
11620 static void
11621 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
11622 {
11623 struct breakpoint *b;
11624 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
11625
11626 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
11627
11628 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
11629 {
11630 struct bp_location *bl;
11631 struct tracepoint *t;
11632 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
11633
11634 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
11635 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
11636 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
11637 continue;
11638
11639 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
11640 {
11641 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
11642 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
11643 else
11644 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
11645 }
11646
11647 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
11648 break;
11649
11650 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
11651 {
11652 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
11653 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
11654 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
11655 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
11656 continue;
11657
11658 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
11659
11660 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
11661
11662 bl->inserted = 1;
11663 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
11664 }
11665 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
11666 t->number_on_target = b->number;
11667 if (bp_location_downloaded)
11668 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
11669 }
11670 }
11671
11672 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
11673
11674 static void
11675 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
11676 {
11677 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
11678 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
11679 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
11680 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
11681
11682 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
11683 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
11684 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
11685 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
11686 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
11687
11688 left->inserted = right->inserted;
11689 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
11690 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
11691 left->target_info = right->target_info;
11692 right->inserted = left_inserted;
11693 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
11694 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
11695 right->target_info = left_target_info;
11696 }
11697
11698 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
11699 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
11700 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
11701 the target. */
11702
11703 static void
11704 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
11705 {
11706 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
11707 struct bp_location *loc;
11708 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
11709 int pspace_num;
11710
11711 address = bl->address;
11712 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
11713
11714 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
11715 evaluating conditions and if the user has
11716 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
11717 side. */
11718 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
11719 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
11720 return;
11721
11722 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
11723 the same program space as the location
11724 as "its condition has changed". We need to
11725 update the conditions on the target's side. */
11726 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
11727 {
11728 loc = *loc2p;
11729
11730 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
11731 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
11732 continue;
11733
11734 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
11735 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
11736 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
11737 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
11738 that have already been marked. */
11739 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
11740
11741 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
11742 it later on. */
11743 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
11744 }
11745 }
11746 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
11747 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
11748 locations are duplicate of which.
11749
11750 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
11751 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
11752 info. */
11753
11754 static void
11755 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
11756 {
11757 struct breakpoint *b;
11758 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
11759 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
11760 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
11761 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
11762 int last_pspace_num = -1;
11763
11764 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
11765 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
11766 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
11767 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
11768 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
11769 once. */
11770 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
11771 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
11772 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
11773 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
11774
11775 /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly
11776 built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
11777 struct bp_location **old_locp;
11778 unsigned old_locations_count;
11779 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<struct bp_location *> old_locations (bp_locations);
11780
11781 old_locations_count = bp_locations_count;
11782 bp_locations = NULL;
11783 bp_locations_count = 0;
11784
11785 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11786 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11787 bp_locations_count++;
11788
11789 bp_locations = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_locations_count);
11790 locp = bp_locations;
11791 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11792 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11793 *locp++ = loc;
11794 qsort (bp_locations, bp_locations_count, sizeof (*bp_locations),
11795 bp_locations_compare);
11796
11797 bp_locations_target_extensions_update ();
11798
11799 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
11800 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
11801 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
11802 if there's another location at the same address (previously
11803 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
11804 location.
11805
11806 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
11807 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
11808
11809 locp = bp_locations;
11810 for (old_locp = old_locations.get ();
11811 old_locp < old_locations.get () + old_locations_count;
11812 old_locp++)
11813 {
11814 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
11815 struct bp_location **loc2p;
11816
11817 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
11818 not, we have to free it. */
11819 int found_object = 0;
11820 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
11821 int keep_in_target = 0;
11822 int removed = 0;
11823
11824 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
11825 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
11826 while (locp < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11827 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
11828 locp++;
11829
11830 for (loc2p = locp;
11831 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11832 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11833 loc2p++)
11834 {
11835 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
11836 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
11837 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
11838 place there. */
11839 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
11840 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
11841 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
11842 {
11843 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
11844 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
11845 }
11846
11847 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
11848 found_object = 1;
11849 }
11850
11851 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
11852 have to go through updates again. */
11853 last_addr = old_loc->address;
11854
11855 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
11856 if (!found_object)
11857 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
11858
11859 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
11860 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
11861 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
11862 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
11863 at certain location is not inserted. */
11864
11865 if (old_loc->inserted)
11866 {
11867 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
11868 it. */
11869
11870 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
11871 {
11872 /* The location is still present in the location list,
11873 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
11874 keep_in_target = 1;
11875 }
11876 else
11877 {
11878 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
11879 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
11880 remove its target-side condition. */
11881
11882 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
11883 disabled. See if there's another location at the
11884 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
11885 this one from the target. */
11886
11887 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
11888 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
11889 {
11890 for (loc2p = locp;
11891 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11892 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11893 loc2p++)
11894 {
11895 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
11896
11897 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
11898 {
11899 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
11900 access watchpoints, if the former are not
11901 supported, but the latter are. */
11902 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
11903 {
11904 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
11905 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
11906 }
11907
11908 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
11909 if it should be inserted in case it will be
11910 unduplicated. */
11911 if (loc2 != old_loc
11912 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
11913 {
11914 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
11915 keep_in_target = 1;
11916 break;
11917 }
11918 }
11919 }
11920 }
11921 }
11922
11923 if (!keep_in_target)
11924 {
11925 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
11926 {
11927 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
11928 this location on the global list, and try to
11929 remove it next time, but there's no particular
11930 reason why we will succeed next time.
11931
11932 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
11933 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
11934 only after calling us. */
11935 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
11936 "breakpoint %d\n"),
11937 old_loc->owner->number);
11938 }
11939 removed = 1;
11940 }
11941 }
11942
11943 if (!found_object)
11944 {
11945 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
11946 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
11947 {
11948 /* This location was removed from the target. In
11949 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
11950 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
11951 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
11952 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
11953 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
11954 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
11955 after we see some number of events. The theory here
11956 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
11957 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
11958 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
11959 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
11960 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
11961 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
11962 SIGTRAP.
11963
11964 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
11965 decr_pc_after_break targets.
11966
11967 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
11968 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
11969 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
11970 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
11971 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
11972 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
11973 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
11974 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
11975 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
11976 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
11977 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
11978 targets that do not support new thread events, like
11979 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
11980 thread_count.
11981
11982 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
11983 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
11984 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
11985 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
11986
11987 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
11988 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
11989 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
11990 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
11991 traps we can no longer explain. */
11992
11993 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
11994 old_loc->owner = NULL;
11995
11996 moribund_locations.push_back (old_loc);
11997 }
11998 else
11999 {
12000 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12001 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12002 }
12003 }
12004 }
12005
12006 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12007 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12008 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12009 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12010 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12011 are sorted first for the same address.
12012
12013 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12014 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12015
12016 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12017 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12018 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12019 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12020 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
12021 {
12022 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12023 non-NULL. */
12024 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12025 b = loc->owner;
12026
12027 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
12028 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
12029 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12030 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12031 `struct bp_location'. */
12032 || is_tracepoint (b))
12033 {
12034 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12035 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12036 continue;
12037 }
12038
12039 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12040 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12041 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12042 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12043 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12044 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12045 else
12046 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12047
12048 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12049 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12050 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12051 {
12052 *loc_first_p = loc;
12053 loc->duplicate = 0;
12054
12055 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12056 {
12057 loc->needs_update = 1;
12058 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12059 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12060 }
12061 continue;
12062 }
12063
12064
12065 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12066 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12067 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12068 if (loc->inserted)
12069 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12070 loc->duplicate = 1;
12071
12072 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12073 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12074 }
12075
12076 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12077 {
12078 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12079 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12080 else
12081 {
12082 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12083 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12084 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12085 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12086 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12087 "needs_update". */
12088 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12089 }
12090 }
12091
12092 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12093 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12094 }
12095
12096 void
12097 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12098 {
12099 for (int ix = 0; ix < moribund_locations.size (); ++ix)
12100 {
12101 struct bp_location *loc = moribund_locations[ix];
12102 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12103 {
12104 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12105 unordered_remove (moribund_locations, ix);
12106 --ix;
12107 }
12108 }
12109 }
12110
12111 static void
12112 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12113 {
12114
12115 TRY
12116 {
12117 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12118 }
12119 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12120 {
12121 }
12122 END_CATCH
12123 }
12124
12125 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12126
12127 static void
12128 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12129 {
12130 bpstat bs;
12131
12132 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12133 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12134 {
12135 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12136 bs->old_val = NULL;
12137 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12138 }
12139 }
12140
12141 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12142 static int
12143 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12144 {
12145 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
12146
12147 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12148 return 0;
12149 }
12150
12151 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12152 callbacks. */
12153
12154 static void
12155 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12156 {
12157 struct value_print_options opts;
12158
12159 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12160
12161 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12162 single string. */
12163 if (b->loc == NULL)
12164 {
12165 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12166 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12167 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12168 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12169 {
12170 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12171 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12172 }
12173 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12174 {
12175 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12176 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12177 b->extra_string);
12178 }
12179 else
12180 {
12181 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12182 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12183 b->extra_string);
12184 }
12185 }
12186 else
12187 {
12188 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12189 {
12190 printf_filtered (" at ");
12191 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12192 gdb_stdout);
12193 }
12194 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12195 {
12196 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12197 more nicely. */
12198 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12199 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
12200 symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab),
12201 b->loc->line_number);
12202 else
12203 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12204 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12205 real situation somewhat. */
12206 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12207 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12208 }
12209
12210 if (b->loc->next)
12211 {
12212 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12213 int n = 0;
12214 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12215 ++n;
12216 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12217 }
12218 }
12219 }
12220
12221 /* Default bp_location_ops methods. */
12222
12223 static void
12224 bp_location_dtor (struct bp_location *self)
12225 {
12226 xfree (self->function_name);
12227 }
12228
12229 static const struct bp_location_ops bp_location_ops =
12230 {
12231 bp_location_dtor
12232 };
12233
12234 /* Destructor for the breakpoint base class. */
12235
12236 breakpoint::~breakpoint ()
12237 {
12238 xfree (this->cond_string);
12239 xfree (this->extra_string);
12240 xfree (this->filter);
12241 }
12242
12243 static struct bp_location *
12244 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12245 {
12246 return new bp_location (&bp_location_ops, self);
12247 }
12248
12249 static void
12250 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12251 {
12252 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12253 }
12254
12255 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12256 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12257
12258 static int
12259 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12260 {
12261 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12262 }
12263
12264 static int
12265 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12266 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12267 {
12268 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12269 }
12270
12271 static int
12272 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12273 const address_space *aspace,
12274 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12275 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12276 {
12277 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12278 }
12279
12280 static void
12281 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12282 {
12283 /* Always stop. */
12284 }
12285
12286 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12287 errors. */
12288
12289 static int
12290 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12291 {
12292 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12293 }
12294
12295 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12296 errors. */
12297
12298 static int
12299 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12300 {
12301 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12302 }
12303
12304 static enum print_stop_action
12305 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12306 {
12307 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12308 }
12309
12310 static void
12311 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12312 struct ui_out *uiout)
12313 {
12314 /* nothing */
12315 }
12316
12317 static void
12318 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12319 {
12320 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12321 }
12322
12323 static void
12324 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12325 {
12326 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12327 }
12328
12329 static void
12330 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
12331 (const struct event_location *location,
12332 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12333 enum bptype type_wanted)
12334 {
12335 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12336 }
12337
12338 static void
12339 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12340 struct linespec_result *c,
12341 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12342 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12343 enum bptype type_wanted,
12344 enum bpdisp disposition,
12345 int thread,
12346 int task, int ignore_count,
12347 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
12348 int from_tty, int enabled,
12349 int internal, unsigned flags)
12350 {
12351 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12352 }
12353
12354 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12355 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12356 const struct event_location *location,
12357 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12358 {
12359 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12360 }
12361
12362 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
12363
12364 static int
12365 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
12366 {
12367 return 1;
12368 }
12369
12370 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
12371
12372 static void
12373 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12374 {
12375 /* Nothing to do. */
12376 }
12377
12378 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
12379 {
12380 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
12381 base_breakpoint_re_set,
12382 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
12383 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
12384 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
12385 base_breakpoint_check_status,
12386 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
12387 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
12388 base_breakpoint_print_it,
12389 NULL,
12390 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
12391 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
12392 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
12393 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
12394 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
12395 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
12396 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
12397 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
12398 };
12399
12400 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12401
12402 static void
12403 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12404 {
12405 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12406 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
12407 {
12408 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
12409 delete_breakpoint (b);
12410 return;
12411 }
12412
12413 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12414 }
12415
12416 static int
12417 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12418 {
12419 CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address;
12420
12421 bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
12422 bl->target_info.placed_address = addr;
12423
12424 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12425 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12426 else
12427 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12428 }
12429
12430 static int
12431 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12432 {
12433 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12434 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12435 else
12436 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
12437 }
12438
12439 static int
12440 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12441 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12442 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12443 {
12444 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12445 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
12446 return 0;
12447
12448 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
12449 aspace, bp_addr))
12450 return 0;
12451
12452 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
12453 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
12454 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
12455 return 0;
12456
12457 return 1;
12458 }
12459
12460 static int
12461 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12462 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12463 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12464 {
12465 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
12466 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
12467 {
12468 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
12469 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
12470 be set at the same address. */
12471 return 0;
12472 }
12473
12474 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
12475 }
12476
12477 static int
12478 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12479 {
12480 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
12481
12482 return 1;
12483 }
12484
12485 static enum print_stop_action
12486 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12487 {
12488 struct breakpoint *b;
12489 const struct bp_location *bl;
12490 int bp_temp;
12491 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12492
12493 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
12494
12495 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
12496 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12497
12498 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
12499 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
12500 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
12501 bl->address,
12502 b->number, 1);
12503 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
12504 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
12505
12506 if (bp_temp)
12507 uiout->text ("Temporary breakpoint ");
12508 else
12509 uiout->text ("Breakpoint ");
12510 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12511 {
12512 uiout->field_string ("reason",
12513 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12514 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12515 }
12516 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
12517 uiout->text (", ");
12518
12519 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12520 }
12521
12522 static void
12523 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12524 {
12525 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12526 return;
12527
12528 switch (b->type)
12529 {
12530 case bp_breakpoint:
12531 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
12532 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
12533 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12534 else
12535 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
12536 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12537 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
12538 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
12539 break;
12540 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
12541 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
12542 break;
12543 case bp_dprintf:
12544 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
12545 break;
12546 }
12547
12548 say_where (b);
12549 }
12550
12551 static void
12552 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12553 {
12554 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12555 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
12556 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
12557 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
12558 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
12559 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12560 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
12561 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
12562 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
12563 else
12564 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12565 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
12566
12567 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12568 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()));
12569
12570 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
12571 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
12572 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
12573 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
12574
12575 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12576 }
12577
12578 static void
12579 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12580 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12581 enum bptype type_wanted)
12582 {
12583 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12584 }
12585
12586 static void
12587 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12588 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12589 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12590 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12591 enum bptype type_wanted,
12592 enum bpdisp disposition,
12593 int thread,
12594 int task, int ignore_count,
12595 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12596 int from_tty, int enabled,
12597 int internal, unsigned flags)
12598 {
12599 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12600 std::move (cond_string),
12601 std::move (extra_string),
12602 type_wanted,
12603 disposition, thread, task,
12604 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12605 enabled, internal, flags);
12606 }
12607
12608 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12609 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12610 const struct event_location *location,
12611 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12612 {
12613 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12614 }
12615
12616 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
12617
12618 static void
12619 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12620 {
12621 switch (b->type)
12622 {
12623 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
12624 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
12625 case bp_overlay_event:
12626 case bp_longjmp_master:
12627 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12628 case bp_exception_master:
12629 delete_breakpoint (b);
12630 break;
12631
12632 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
12633 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
12634 case bp_shlib_event:
12635
12636 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
12637 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
12638 case bp_thread_event:
12639 break;
12640 }
12641 }
12642
12643 static void
12644 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12645 {
12646 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
12647 {
12648 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
12649 events. This allows the user to get control and place
12650 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
12651 objects (among other things). */
12652 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
12653 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
12654 }
12655 else
12656 bs->stop = 0;
12657 }
12658
12659 static enum print_stop_action
12660 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12661 {
12662 struct breakpoint *b;
12663
12664 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12665
12666 switch (b->type)
12667 {
12668 case bp_shlib_event:
12669 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
12670 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
12671 to shlib event" message.) */
12672 print_solib_event (0);
12673 break;
12674
12675 case bp_thread_event:
12676 /* Not sure how we will get here.
12677 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
12678 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12679 break;
12680
12681 case bp_overlay_event:
12682 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
12683 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12684 break;
12685
12686 case bp_longjmp_master:
12687 /* These should never be enabled. */
12688 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12689 break;
12690
12691 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12692 /* These should never be enabled. */
12693 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
12694 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12695 break;
12696
12697 case bp_exception_master:
12698 /* These should never be enabled. */
12699 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
12700 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12701 break;
12702 }
12703
12704 return PRINT_NOTHING;
12705 }
12706
12707 static void
12708 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12709 {
12710 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12711 }
12712
12713 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
12714
12715 static void
12716 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12717 {
12718 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
12719 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
12720 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
12721 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
12722 }
12723
12724 static void
12725 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12726 {
12727 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
12728 }
12729
12730 static enum print_stop_action
12731 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12732 {
12733 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
12734 }
12735
12736 static void
12737 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12738 {
12739 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12740 }
12741
12742 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
12743
12744 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
12745 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
12746
12747 longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint ()
12748 {
12749 thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread);
12750
12751 if (tp != NULL)
12752 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
12753 }
12754
12755 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
12756
12757 static int
12758 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12759 {
12760 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
12761
12762 if (v == 0)
12763 {
12764 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
12765 if needed. */
12766 bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12767 }
12768
12769 return v;
12770 }
12771
12772 static int
12773 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12774 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12775 {
12776 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
12777 bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12778
12779 return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
12780 }
12781
12782 static void
12783 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12784 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12785 enum bptype type_wanted)
12786 {
12787 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12788
12789 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
12790 lsal.canonical
12791 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12792 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12793 }
12794
12795 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12796 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12797 const struct event_location *location,
12798 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12799 {
12800 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
12801 if (sals.empty ())
12802 error (_("probe not found"));
12803 return sals;
12804 }
12805
12806 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
12807
12808 static void
12809 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12810 {
12811 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12812 }
12813
12814 static int
12815 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12816 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12817 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12818 {
12819 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
12820 tracepoints. */
12821 return 0;
12822 }
12823
12824 static void
12825 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12826 struct ui_out *uiout)
12827 {
12828 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12829 if (!tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
12830 {
12831 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
12832
12833 uiout->text ("\tmarker id is ");
12834 uiout->field_string ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
12835 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
12836 uiout->text ("\n");
12837 }
12838 }
12839
12840 static void
12841 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12842 {
12843 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12844 return;
12845
12846 switch (b->type)
12847 {
12848 case bp_tracepoint:
12849 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
12850 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12851 break;
12852 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
12853 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
12854 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12855 break;
12856 case bp_static_tracepoint:
12857 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
12858 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12859 break;
12860 default:
12861 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12862 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
12863 }
12864
12865 say_where (b);
12866 }
12867
12868 static void
12869 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
12870 {
12871 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12872
12873 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
12874 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
12875 else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
12876 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
12877 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
12878 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
12879 else
12880 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12881 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
12882
12883 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12884 event_location_to_string (self->location.get ()));
12885 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
12886
12887 if (tp->pass_count)
12888 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
12889 }
12890
12891 static void
12892 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12893 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12894 enum bptype type_wanted)
12895 {
12896 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12897 }
12898
12899 static void
12900 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12901 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12902 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12903 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12904 enum bptype type_wanted,
12905 enum bpdisp disposition,
12906 int thread,
12907 int task, int ignore_count,
12908 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12909 int from_tty, int enabled,
12910 int internal, unsigned flags)
12911 {
12912 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12913 std::move (cond_string),
12914 std::move (extra_string),
12915 type_wanted,
12916 disposition, thread, task,
12917 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12918 enabled, internal, flags);
12919 }
12920
12921 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12922 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12923 const struct event_location *location,
12924 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12925 {
12926 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12927 }
12928
12929 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
12930
12931 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
12932 static probe. */
12933
12934 static void
12935 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
12936 (const struct event_location *location,
12937 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12938 enum bptype type_wanted)
12939 {
12940 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12941 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12942 }
12943
12944 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12945 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12946 const struct event_location *location,
12947 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12948 {
12949 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12950 return bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
12951 }
12952
12953 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
12954
12955 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
12956
12957 static void
12958 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12959 {
12960 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12961
12962 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
12963 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
12964
12965 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
12966 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
12967 3 - disconnect from target 1
12968 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
12969
12970 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
12971 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
12972 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
12973 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
12974 it all the time. */
12975 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
12976 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
12977 }
12978
12979 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
12980
12981 static void
12982 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12983 {
12984 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
12985 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()),
12986 tp->extra_string);
12987 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12988 }
12989
12990 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
12991 dprintf.
12992
12993 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
12994 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
12995 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
12996 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
12997 address are all handled. */
12998
12999 static void
13000 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13001 {
13002 struct bpstats tmp_bs;
13003 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
13004
13005 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
13006 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
13007 condition not be evaluated. */
13008 bs->stop = 0;
13009
13010 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
13011 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
13012 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
13013 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
13014 commands here throws. */
13015 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
13016 bs->commands = NULL;
13017
13018 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
13019
13020 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
13021 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
13022 list. */
13023 }
13024
13025 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13026 markers (`-m'). */
13027
13028 static void
13029 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13030 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13031 enum bptype type_wanted)
13032 {
13033 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13034 const char *arg_start, *arg;
13035
13036 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13037 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
13038
13039 std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
13040 const char *ptr = str.c_str ();
13041 canonical->location
13042 = new_linespec_location (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
13043
13044 lsal.canonical
13045 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
13046 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
13047 }
13048
13049 static void
13050 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13051 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13052 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13053 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13054 enum bptype type_wanted,
13055 enum bpdisp disposition,
13056 int thread,
13057 int task, int ignore_count,
13058 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13059 int from_tty, int enabled,
13060 int internal, unsigned flags)
13061 {
13062 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0];
13063
13064 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13065 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13066 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13067 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13068 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13069 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13070
13071 for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++)
13072 {
13073 event_location_up location
13074 = copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ());
13075
13076 std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp (new tracepoint ());
13077 init_breakpoint_sal (tp.get (), gdbarch, lsal.sals[i],
13078 std::move (location), NULL,
13079 std::move (cond_string),
13080 std::move (extra_string),
13081 type_wanted, disposition,
13082 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13083 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13084 canonical->special_display);
13085 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13086 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13087 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13088 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13089 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13090 corresponds to this one */
13091 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13092
13093 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0);
13094 }
13095 }
13096
13097 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13098 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13099 const struct event_location *location,
13100 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13101 {
13102 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13103 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13104
13105 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
13106 if (sals.size () > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13107 {
13108 sals[0] = sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13109 sals.resize (1);
13110 return sals;
13111 }
13112 else
13113 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13114 }
13115
13116 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13117
13118 static int
13119 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13120 {
13121 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13122 }
13123
13124 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13125 structures. */
13126
13127 void
13128 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13129 {
13130 struct breakpoint *b;
13131
13132 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13133
13134 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13135 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13136 especial culprits.
13137
13138 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13139 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13140 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13141 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13142 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13143 deleted.
13144
13145 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13146 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13147 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13148 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13149 was chosen. */
13150 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13151 return;
13152
13153 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13154 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13155 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13156 {
13157 struct breakpoint *related;
13158 struct watchpoint *w;
13159
13160 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13161 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13162 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13163 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13164 else
13165 w = NULL;
13166 if (w != NULL)
13167 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13168
13169 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13170 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13171 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13172 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13173 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13174 }
13175
13176 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13177 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13178 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13179 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13180 if (bpt->number)
13181 gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted.notify (bpt);
13182
13183 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13184 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13185
13186 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13187 if (b->next == bpt)
13188 {
13189 b->next = bpt->next;
13190 break;
13191 }
13192
13193 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13194 been freed. */
13195 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13196 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13197 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13198 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13199 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13200 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13201 commands won't work. */
13202
13203 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13204
13205 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13206 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13207 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13208 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13209 might be better design to have location completely
13210 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13211 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13212
13213 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13214 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13215 bpt->type = bp_none;
13216 delete bpt;
13217 }
13218
13219 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13220 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13221
13222 static void
13223 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13224 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13225 {
13226 struct breakpoint *related;
13227
13228 related = b;
13229 do
13230 {
13231 struct breakpoint *next;
13232
13233 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13234 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13235
13236 if (next == related)
13237 {
13238 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13239 function (related);
13240
13241 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13242 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13243 out. */
13244 break;
13245 }
13246 else
13247 function (related);
13248
13249 related = next;
13250 }
13251 while (related != b);
13252 }
13253
13254 static void
13255 delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
13256 {
13257 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13258
13259 dont_repeat ();
13260
13261 if (arg == 0)
13262 {
13263 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13264
13265 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13266 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13267 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13268 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13269 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13270 {
13271 breaks_to_delete = 1;
13272 break;
13273 }
13274
13275 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13276 if (!from_tty
13277 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13278 {
13279 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13280 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13281 delete_breakpoint (b);
13282 }
13283 }
13284 else
13285 map_breakpoint_numbers
13286 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
13287 {
13288 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
13289 });
13290 }
13291
13292 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
13293 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
13294 considered. */
13295
13296 static int
13297 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13298 {
13299 struct bp_location *loc;
13300
13301 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
13302 if ((pspace == NULL
13303 || loc->pspace == pspace)
13304 && !loc->shlib_disabled
13305 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13306 return 0;
13307 return 1;
13308 }
13309
13310 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13311 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13312 Null names are ignored. */
13313
13314 static int
13315 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
13316 {
13317 struct bp_location *l;
13318 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string, streq_hash, NULL,
13319 xcalloc, xfree);
13320
13321 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
13322 {
13323 const char **slot;
13324 const char *name = l->function_name;
13325
13326 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13327 if (name == NULL)
13328 continue;
13329
13330 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
13331 INSERT);
13332 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13333 returns NULL. */
13334 if (*slot != NULL)
13335 {
13336 htab_delete (htab);
13337 return 1;
13338 }
13339 *slot = name;
13340 }
13341
13342 htab_delete (htab);
13343 return 0;
13344 }
13345
13346 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13347 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13348 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13349 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13350 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13351 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13352 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13353 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13354 The heuristic is:
13355
13356 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13357 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13358 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13359 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13360 in the sources, and output a warning.
13361
13362 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13363 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13364 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13365 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13366 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13367 warning.
13368
13369 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13370 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13371 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13372 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13373 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13374 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13375 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13376 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13377 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13378
13379 static struct symtab_and_line
13380 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
13381 {
13382 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13383 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
13384 CORE_ADDR pc;
13385
13386 pc = sal.pc;
13387 if (sal.line)
13388 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
13389
13390 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
13391 {
13392 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id != marker.str_id)
13393 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13394 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str (),
13395 marker.str_id.c_str ());
13396
13397 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
13398
13399 return sal;
13400 }
13401
13402 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13403 by string ID. */
13404 if (!sal.explicit_pc
13405 && sal.line != 0
13406 && sal.symtab != NULL
13407 && !tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
13408 {
13409 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
13410 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid
13411 (tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13412
13413 if (!markers.empty ())
13414 {
13415 struct symbol *sym;
13416 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
13417 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13418 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
13419
13420 tpmarker = &markers[0];
13421
13422 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (tpmarker->str_id);
13423
13424 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
13425 "found at previous line number"),
13426 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13427
13428 symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
13429 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
13430 uiout->text ("Now in ");
13431 if (sym)
13432 {
13433 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
13434 uiout->text (" at ");
13435 }
13436 uiout->field_string ("file",
13437 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13438 uiout->text (":");
13439
13440 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
13441 {
13442 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
13443
13444 uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname);
13445 }
13446
13447 uiout->field_int ("line", sal2.line);
13448 uiout->text ("\n");
13449
13450 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
13451 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
13452
13453 b->location.reset (NULL);
13454 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13455 explicit_loc.source_filename
13456 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13457 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
13458 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
13459 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13460
13461 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
13462 so. */
13463 }
13464 }
13465 return sal;
13466 }
13467
13468 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
13469 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
13470
13471 static int
13472 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
13473 {
13474 while (a && b)
13475 {
13476 if (a->address != b->address)
13477 return 0;
13478
13479 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
13480 return 0;
13481
13482 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
13483 return 0;
13484
13485 a = a->next;
13486 b = b->next;
13487 }
13488
13489 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
13490 return 0;
13491
13492 return 1;
13493 }
13494
13495 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
13496 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
13497 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
13498
13499 static struct bp_location *
13500 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13501 {
13502 struct bp_location head;
13503 struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
13504 struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
13505 struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
13506
13507 if (pspace == NULL)
13508 {
13509 i = b->loc;
13510 b->loc = NULL;
13511 return i;
13512 }
13513
13514 head.next = NULL;
13515
13516 while (i != NULL)
13517 {
13518 if (i->pspace == pspace)
13519 {
13520 *i_link = i->next;
13521 i->next = NULL;
13522 hoisted->next = i;
13523 hoisted = i;
13524 }
13525 else
13526 i_link = &i->next;
13527 i = *i_link;
13528 }
13529
13530 return head.next;
13531 }
13532
13533 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
13534 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
13535 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
13536 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
13537 untouched. */
13538
13539 void
13540 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
13541 struct program_space *filter_pspace,
13542 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
13543 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end)
13544 {
13545 struct bp_location *existing_locations;
13546
13547 if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1))
13548 {
13549 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
13550 location. */
13551 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13552 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
13553 "multiple locations found\n"),
13554 b->number);
13555 return;
13556 }
13557
13558 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
13559 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
13560 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
13561 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
13562 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
13563 individual locations. */
13564 if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ())
13565 return;
13566
13567 existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
13568
13569 for (const auto &sal : sals)
13570 {
13571 struct bp_location *new_loc;
13572
13573 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
13574
13575 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
13576
13577 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
13578 old symtab. */
13579 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
13580 {
13581 const char *s;
13582
13583 s = b->cond_string;
13584 TRY
13585 {
13586 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc,
13587 block_for_pc (sal.pc),
13588 0);
13589 }
13590 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13591 {
13592 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
13593 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
13594 b->number, e.message);
13595 new_loc->enabled = 0;
13596 }
13597 END_CATCH
13598 }
13599
13600 if (!sals_end.empty ())
13601 {
13602 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]);
13603
13604 new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1;
13605 }
13606 }
13607
13608 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
13609 breakpoints. */
13610 {
13611 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
13612 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
13613 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
13614 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
13615 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
13616 often enough until a better solution is found. */
13617 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
13618
13619 for (; e; e = e->next)
13620 {
13621 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
13622 {
13623 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
13624 if (have_ambiguous_names)
13625 {
13626 for (; l; l = l->next)
13627 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
13628 {
13629 l->enabled = 0;
13630 break;
13631 }
13632 }
13633 else
13634 {
13635 for (; l; l = l->next)
13636 if (l->function_name
13637 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
13638 {
13639 l->enabled = 0;
13640 break;
13641 }
13642 }
13643 }
13644 }
13645 }
13646
13647 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
13648 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13649 }
13650
13651 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
13652 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
13653
13654 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13655 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
13656 struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
13657 {
13658 struct gdb_exception exception = exception_none;
13659
13660 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
13661
13662 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
13663
13664 TRY
13665 {
13666 sals = b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
13667 }
13668 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13669 {
13670 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
13671
13672 exception = e;
13673
13674 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
13675 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
13676 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
13677 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
13678 state, then user already saw the message about that
13679 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
13680 errors. */
13681 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
13682 && (b->condition_not_parsed
13683 || (b->loc != NULL
13684 && search_pspace != NULL
13685 && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
13686 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
13687 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13688 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
13689 not_found_and_ok = 1;
13690
13691 if (!not_found_and_ok)
13692 {
13693 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
13694 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
13695 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
13696 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
13697 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
13698 which approach is better. */
13699 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13700 throw_exception (e);
13701 }
13702 }
13703 END_CATCH
13704
13705 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
13706 {
13707 for (auto &sal : sals)
13708 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
13709 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
13710 {
13711 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
13712 int thread, task;
13713
13714 find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals[0].pc,
13715 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
13716 &extra_string);
13717 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
13718 if (cond_string)
13719 b->cond_string = cond_string;
13720 b->thread = thread;
13721 b->task = task;
13722 if (extra_string)
13723 {
13724 xfree (b->extra_string);
13725 b->extra_string = extra_string;
13726 }
13727 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
13728 }
13729
13730 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
13731 sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals[0]);
13732
13733 *found = 1;
13734 }
13735 else
13736 *found = 0;
13737
13738 return sals;
13739 }
13740
13741 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
13742 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
13743 locations. */
13744
13745 static void
13746 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
13747 {
13748 struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
13749 std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end;
13750
13751 int found;
13752 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location.get (),
13753 filter_pspace, &found);
13754 if (found)
13755 expanded = std::move (sals);
13756
13757 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
13758 {
13759 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end
13760 = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end.get (),
13761 filter_pspace, &found);
13762 if (found)
13763 expanded_end = std::move (sals_end);
13764 }
13765
13766 update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
13767 }
13768
13769 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
13770 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
13771
13772 static void
13773 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
13774 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13775 enum bptype type_wanted)
13776 {
13777 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
13778 }
13779
13780 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
13781 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
13782 breakpoint_ops. */
13783
13784 static void
13785 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13786 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13787 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13788 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13789 enum bptype type_wanted,
13790 enum bpdisp disposition,
13791 int thread,
13792 int task, int ignore_count,
13793 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13794 int from_tty, int enabled,
13795 int internal, unsigned flags)
13796 {
13797 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical,
13798 std::move (cond_string),
13799 std::move (extra_string),
13800 type_wanted, disposition,
13801 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13802 enabled, internal, flags);
13803 }
13804
13805 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
13806 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
13807
13808 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13809 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
13810 const struct event_location *location,
13811 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13812 {
13813 struct linespec_result canonical;
13814
13815 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
13816 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
13817 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
13818 b->filter);
13819
13820 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
13821 gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2);
13822
13823 if (!canonical.lsals.empty ())
13824 {
13825 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
13826 return std::move (lsal.sals);
13827 }
13828 return {};
13829 }
13830
13831 /* Reset a breakpoint. */
13832
13833 static void
13834 breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b)
13835 {
13836 input_radix = b->input_radix;
13837 set_language (b->language);
13838
13839 b->ops->re_set (b);
13840 }
13841
13842 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
13843 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
13844
13845 void
13846 breakpoint_re_set (void)
13847 {
13848 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13849
13850 {
13851 scoped_restore_current_language save_language;
13852 scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix);
13853 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
13854
13855 /* breakpoint_re_set_one sets the current_language to the language
13856 of the breakpoint it is resetting (see prepare_re_set_context)
13857 before re-evaluating the breakpoint's location. This change can
13858 unfortunately get undone by accident if the language_mode is set
13859 to auto, and we either switch frames, or more likely in this context,
13860 we select the current frame.
13861
13862 We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to
13863 language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints
13864 have been reset. */
13865 scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode);
13866 language_mode = language_mode_manual;
13867
13868 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
13869 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
13870 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
13871 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
13872
13873 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13874 {
13875 TRY
13876 {
13877 breakpoint_re_set_one (b);
13878 }
13879 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
13880 {
13881 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
13882 "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
13883 b->number);
13884 }
13885 END_CATCH
13886 }
13887
13888 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
13889 }
13890
13891 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
13892 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
13893 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
13894 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
13895
13896 /* Now we can insert. */
13897 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
13898 }
13899 \f
13900 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
13901
13902 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
13903 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
13904 void
13905 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
13906 {
13907 if (b->thread != -1)
13908 {
13909 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
13910
13911 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
13912 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
13913 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
13914 as well. */
13915 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
13916 }
13917 }
13918
13919 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
13920 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
13921 which ends with a period (no newline). */
13922
13923 void
13924 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
13925 {
13926 struct breakpoint *b;
13927
13928 if (count < 0)
13929 count = 0;
13930
13931 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13932 if (b->number == bptnum)
13933 {
13934 if (is_tracepoint (b))
13935 {
13936 if (from_tty && count != 0)
13937 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
13938 bptnum);
13939 return;
13940 }
13941
13942 b->ignore_count = count;
13943 if (from_tty)
13944 {
13945 if (count == 0)
13946 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
13947 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
13948 bptnum);
13949 else if (count == 1)
13950 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
13951 bptnum);
13952 else
13953 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
13954 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
13955 count, bptnum);
13956 }
13957 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13958 return;
13959 }
13960
13961 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
13962 }
13963
13964 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
13965
13966 static void
13967 ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
13968 {
13969 const char *p = args;
13970 int num;
13971
13972 if (p == 0)
13973 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
13974
13975 num = get_number (&p);
13976 if (num == 0)
13977 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
13978 if (*p == 0)
13979 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
13980
13981 set_ignore_count (num,
13982 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
13983 from_tty);
13984 if (from_tty)
13985 printf_filtered ("\n");
13986 }
13987 \f
13988
13989 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range
13990 defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */
13991
13992 static void
13993 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range,
13994 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13995 {
13996 if (bp_num_range.first == 0)
13997 {
13998 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"),
13999 bp_num_range.first);
14000 }
14001 else
14002 {
14003 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
14004
14005 for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++)
14006 {
14007 bool match = false;
14008
14009 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
14010 if (b->number == i)
14011 {
14012 match = true;
14013 function (b);
14014 break;
14015 }
14016 if (!match)
14017 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i);
14018 }
14019 }
14020 }
14021
14022 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in
14023 ARGS. */
14024
14025 static void
14026 map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args,
14027 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
14028 {
14029 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14030 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14031
14032 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14033
14034 while (!parser.finished ())
14035 {
14036 int num = parser.get_number ();
14037 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function);
14038 }
14039 }
14040
14041 /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the
14042 BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */
14043
14044 static struct bp_location *
14045 find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num)
14046 {
14047 struct breakpoint *b;
14048
14049 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14050 if (b->number == bp_num)
14051 {
14052 break;
14053 }
14054
14055 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14056 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num);
14057
14058 if (loc_num == 0)
14059 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14060
14061 int n = 0;
14062 for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14063 if (++n == loc_num)
14064 return loc;
14065
14066 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14067 }
14068
14069 /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */
14070 enum class extract_bp_kind
14071 {
14072 /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */
14073 bp,
14074
14075 /* Extracting a location number. */
14076 loc,
14077 };
14078
14079 /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND)
14080 from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which
14081 can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use
14082 '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed
14083 string. This always returns a positive integer. */
14084
14085 static int
14086 extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start,
14087 int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL)
14088 {
14089 const char *end = start;
14090 int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer);
14091 if (num < 0)
14092 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14093 ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14094 : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14095 int (end - start), start);
14096 if (num == 0)
14097 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14098 ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14099 : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14100 int (end - start), start);
14101
14102 if (end_out != NULL)
14103 *end_out = end;
14104 return num;
14105 }
14106
14107 /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in
14108 the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair
14109 representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements
14110 are always positive integers. */
14111
14112 static std::pair<int, int>
14113 extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind,
14114 const std::string &arg,
14115 std::string::size_type arg_offset)
14116 {
14117 std::pair<int, int> range;
14118 const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset];
14119 std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset);
14120 if (dash != std::string::npos)
14121 {
14122 /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */
14123 if (arg.length () == dash + 1)
14124 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14125 ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'")
14126 : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"),
14127 bp_loc);
14128
14129 const char *end;
14130 const char *start_first = bp_loc;
14131 const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1];
14132 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-');
14133 range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end);
14134
14135 if (range.first > range.second)
14136 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14137 ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'")
14138 : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"),
14139 int (end - start_first), start_first);
14140 }
14141 else
14142 {
14143 /* bp_loc is a single value. */
14144 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0');
14145 range.second = range.first;
14146 }
14147 return range;
14148 }
14149
14150 /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns
14151 the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in
14152 BP_LOC_RANGE.
14153
14154 ARG may be in any of the following forms:
14155
14156 x where 'x' is a breakpoint number.
14157 x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range.
14158 x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number.
14159 x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a
14160 location number range.
14161 */
14162
14163 static void
14164 extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg,
14165 std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range,
14166 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range)
14167 {
14168 std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.');
14169
14170 if (dot != std::string::npos)
14171 {
14172 /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */
14173
14174 if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0)
14175 error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ());
14176
14177 bp_num_range.first
14178 = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.');
14179 bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first;
14180
14181 bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc,
14182 arg, dot + 1);
14183 }
14184 else
14185 {
14186 /* Handle x and x-y cases. */
14187
14188 bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0);
14189 bp_loc_range.first = 0;
14190 bp_loc_range.second = 0;
14191 }
14192 }
14193
14194 /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE
14195 specifies whether to enable or disable. */
14196
14197 static void
14198 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable)
14199 {
14200 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num);
14201 if (loc != NULL)
14202 {
14203 if (loc->enabled != enable)
14204 {
14205 loc->enabled = enable;
14206 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14207 }
14208 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14209 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14210 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14211 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14212 }
14213 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14214
14215 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (loc->owner);
14216 }
14217
14218 /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the
14219 number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the
14220 (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to
14221 enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the
14222 location. */
14223
14224 static void
14225 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num,
14226 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range,
14227 bool enable)
14228 {
14229 for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++)
14230 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable);
14231 }
14232
14233 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14234 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14235 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14236
14237 void
14238 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14239 {
14240 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14241 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14242 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14243 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14244 return;
14245
14246 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14247
14248 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14249 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14250
14251 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14252 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14253 {
14254 struct bp_location *location;
14255
14256 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14257 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14258 }
14259
14260 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14261
14262 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14263 }
14264
14265 /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s)
14266 specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by
14267 extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable
14268 or disable the breakpoints/locations. */
14269
14270 static void
14271 enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable)
14272 {
14273 if (args == 0)
14274 {
14275 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14276
14277 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14278 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14279 {
14280 if (enable)
14281 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14282 else
14283 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14284 }
14285 }
14286 else
14287 {
14288 std::string num = extract_arg (&args);
14289
14290 while (!num.empty ())
14291 {
14292 std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range;
14293
14294 extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range);
14295
14296 if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second
14297 && bp_loc_range.first == 0)
14298 {
14299 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */
14300 map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range,
14301 enable
14302 ? enable_breakpoint
14303 : disable_breakpoint);
14304 }
14305 else
14306 {
14307 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or
14308 'x.y-z'. */
14309 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range
14310 (bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable);
14311 }
14312 num = extract_arg (&args);
14313 }
14314 }
14315 }
14316
14317 /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations
14318 (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in
14319 stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in
14320 extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14321
14322 static void
14323 disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14324 {
14325 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false);
14326 }
14327
14328 static void
14329 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14330 int count)
14331 {
14332 int target_resources_ok;
14333
14334 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14335 {
14336 int i;
14337 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14338 target_resources_ok =
14339 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14340 i + 1, 0);
14341 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14342 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14343 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14344 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14345 }
14346
14347 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14348 {
14349 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14350 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14351
14352 TRY
14353 {
14354 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14355
14356 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14357 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14358 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14359 }
14360 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
14361 {
14362 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14363 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14364 bpt->number);
14365 return;
14366 }
14367 END_CATCH
14368 }
14369
14370 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14371
14372 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14373 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14374
14375 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14376 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14377 {
14378 struct bp_location *location;
14379
14380 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14381 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14382 }
14383
14384 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14385 bpt->enable_count = count;
14386 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14387
14388 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14389 }
14390
14391
14392 void
14393 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14394 {
14395 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14396 }
14397
14398 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or
14399 all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to
14400 be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the
14401 forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14402
14403 static void
14404 enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14405 {
14406 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true);
14407 }
14408
14409 static void
14410 enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14411 {
14412 map_breakpoint_numbers
14413 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14414 {
14415 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14416 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14417 {
14418 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1);
14419 });
14420 });
14421 }
14422
14423 static void
14424 enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14425 {
14426 int count;
14427
14428 if (args == NULL)
14429 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
14430
14431 count = get_number (&args);
14432
14433 map_breakpoint_numbers
14434 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14435 {
14436 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14437 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14438 {
14439 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count);
14440 });
14441 });
14442 }
14443
14444 static void
14445 enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14446 {
14447 map_breakpoint_numbers
14448 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14449 {
14450 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14451 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14452 {
14453 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1);
14454 });
14455 });
14456 }
14457 \f
14458 static void
14459 set_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14460 {
14461 }
14462
14463 static void
14464 show_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14465 {
14466 }
14467
14468 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14469 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14470 GDB itself. */
14471
14472 static void
14473 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
14474 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
14475 const bfd_byte *data)
14476 {
14477 struct breakpoint *bp;
14478
14479 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
14480 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
14481 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
14482 {
14483 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
14484
14485 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val != nullptr)
14486 {
14487 struct bp_location *loc;
14488
14489 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14490 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14491 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
14492 && addr + len > loc->address)
14493 {
14494 wp->val = NULL;
14495 wp->val_valid = 0;
14496 }
14497 }
14498 }
14499 }
14500
14501 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14502
14503 void
14504 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14505 const address_space *aspace,
14506 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
14507 {
14508 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
14509 struct symtab_and_line sal;
14510 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
14511
14512 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
14513 {
14514 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
14515 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
14516 }
14517
14518 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
14519 sal.pc = pc;
14520 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
14521 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
14522 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
14523
14524 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
14525 }
14526
14527 /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
14528
14529 int
14530 insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
14531 {
14532 struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache ();
14533 std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs;
14534
14535 next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache);
14536
14537 if (!next_pcs.empty ())
14538 {
14539 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
14540 const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame);
14541
14542 for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs)
14543 insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc);
14544
14545 return 1;
14546 }
14547 else
14548 return 0;
14549 }
14550
14551 /* See breakpoint.h. */
14552
14553 int
14554 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
14555 const address_space *aspace,
14556 CORE_ADDR pc)
14557 {
14558 struct bp_location *loc;
14559
14560 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14561 if (loc->inserted
14562 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
14563 return 1;
14564
14565 return 0;
14566 }
14567
14568 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
14569 PC. */
14570
14571 int
14572 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
14573 CORE_ADDR pc)
14574 {
14575 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14576
14577 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14578 {
14579 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
14580 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
14581 return 1;
14582 }
14583 return 0;
14584 }
14585
14586 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14587
14588 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14589 static void
14590 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
14591 {
14592 tracepoint_count = num;
14593 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
14594 }
14595
14596 static void
14597 trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14598 {
14599 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14600
14601 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14602 current_language);
14603 if (location != NULL
14604 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
14605 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
14606 else
14607 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14608
14609 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14610 location.get (),
14611 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14612 0 /* tempflag */,
14613 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14614 0 /* Ignore count */,
14615 pending_break_support,
14616 ops,
14617 from_tty,
14618 1 /* enabled */,
14619 0 /* internal */, 0);
14620 }
14621
14622 static void
14623 ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14624 {
14625 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14626 current_language);
14627 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14628 location.get (),
14629 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14630 0 /* tempflag */,
14631 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14632 0 /* Ignore count */,
14633 pending_break_support,
14634 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14635 from_tty,
14636 1 /* enabled */,
14637 0 /* internal */, 0);
14638 }
14639
14640 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
14641
14642 static void
14643 strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14644 {
14645 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14646 event_location_up location;
14647
14648 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
14649 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
14650 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
14651 {
14652 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
14653 location = new_linespec_location (&arg, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
14654 }
14655 else
14656 {
14657 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14658 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
14659 }
14660
14661 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14662 location.get (),
14663 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14664 0 /* tempflag */,
14665 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14666 0 /* Ignore count */,
14667 pending_break_support,
14668 ops,
14669 from_tty,
14670 1 /* enabled */,
14671 0 /* internal */, 0);
14672 }
14673
14674 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
14675 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
14676
14677 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
14678 static int next_cmd;
14679
14680 static char *
14681 read_uploaded_action (void)
14682 {
14683 char *rslt = nullptr;
14684
14685 if (next_cmd < this_utp->cmd_strings.size ())
14686 {
14687 rslt = this_utp->cmd_strings[next_cmd];
14688 next_cmd++;
14689 }
14690
14691 return rslt;
14692 }
14693
14694 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
14695 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
14696 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
14697 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
14698 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
14699
14700 struct tracepoint *
14701 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
14702 {
14703 const char *addr_str;
14704 char small_buf[100];
14705 struct tracepoint *tp;
14706
14707 if (utp->at_string)
14708 addr_str = utp->at_string;
14709 else
14710 {
14711 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
14712 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
14713 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
14714 user. */
14715 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
14716 "source location, using raw address"),
14717 utp->number);
14718 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
14719 addr_str = small_buf;
14720 }
14721
14722 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
14723 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
14724 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
14725 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
14726 utp->number);
14727
14728 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str,
14729 current_language);
14730 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14731 location.get (),
14732 utp->cond_string, -1, addr_str,
14733 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
14734 0 /* tempflag */,
14735 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
14736 0 /* Ignore count */,
14737 pending_break_support,
14738 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14739 0 /* from_tty */,
14740 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
14741 0 /* internal */,
14742 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
14743 return NULL;
14744
14745 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
14746 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
14747 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
14748
14749 if (utp->pass > 0)
14750 {
14751 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
14752 tp->number);
14753
14754 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
14755 }
14756
14757 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
14758 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
14759 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
14760 function. */
14761 if (!utp->cmd_strings.empty ())
14762 {
14763 counted_command_line cmd_list;
14764
14765 this_utp = utp;
14766 next_cmd = 0;
14767
14768 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL);
14769
14770 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list));
14771 }
14772 else if (!utp->actions.empty ()
14773 || !utp->step_actions.empty ())
14774 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
14775 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
14776 utp->number);
14777
14778 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
14779 tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count;
14780 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
14781
14782 return tp;
14783 }
14784
14785 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
14786 omitted. */
14787
14788 static void
14789 info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14790 {
14791 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14792 int num_printed;
14793
14794 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
14795
14796 if (num_printed == 0)
14797 {
14798 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14799 uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n");
14800 else
14801 uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
14802 }
14803
14804 default_collect_info ();
14805 }
14806
14807 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
14808 Not supported by all targets. */
14809 static void
14810 enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14811 {
14812 enable_command (args, from_tty);
14813 }
14814
14815 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
14816 Not supported by all targets. */
14817 static void
14818 disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14819 {
14820 disable_command (args, from_tty);
14821 }
14822
14823 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
14824 static void
14825 delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14826 {
14827 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14828
14829 dont_repeat ();
14830
14831 if (arg == 0)
14832 {
14833 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14834
14835 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
14836 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
14837 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
14838 argument. */
14839 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14840 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14841 {
14842 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14843 break;
14844 }
14845
14846 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14847 if (!from_tty
14848 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
14849 {
14850 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14851 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14852 delete_breakpoint (b);
14853 }
14854 }
14855 else
14856 map_breakpoint_numbers
14857 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
14858 {
14859 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
14860 });
14861 }
14862
14863 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
14864
14865 static void
14866 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
14867 {
14868 tp->pass_count = count;
14869 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (tp);
14870 if (from_tty)
14871 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
14872 tp->number, count);
14873 }
14874
14875 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
14876
14877 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
14878 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
14879 Also accepts special argument "all". */
14880
14881 static void
14882 trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14883 {
14884 struct tracepoint *t1;
14885 ULONGEST count;
14886
14887 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
14888 error (_("passcount command requires an "
14889 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
14890
14891 count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
14892
14893 args = skip_spaces (args);
14894 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
14895 {
14896 struct breakpoint *b;
14897
14898 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
14899 if (*args)
14900 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
14901
14902 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14903 {
14904 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14905 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14906 }
14907 }
14908 else if (*args == '\0')
14909 {
14910 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
14911 if (t1)
14912 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14913 }
14914 else
14915 {
14916 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14917 while (!parser.finished ())
14918 {
14919 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
14920 if (t1)
14921 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14922 }
14923 }
14924 }
14925
14926 struct tracepoint *
14927 get_tracepoint (int num)
14928 {
14929 struct breakpoint *t;
14930
14931 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
14932 if (t->number == num)
14933 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14934
14935 return NULL;
14936 }
14937
14938 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
14939 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
14940 reconnecting). */
14941
14942 struct tracepoint *
14943 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
14944 {
14945 struct breakpoint *b;
14946
14947 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14948 {
14949 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14950
14951 if (t->number_on_target == num)
14952 return t;
14953 }
14954
14955 return NULL;
14956 }
14957
14958 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
14959 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
14960 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
14961 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
14962
14963 struct tracepoint *
14964 get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg,
14965 number_or_range_parser *parser)
14966 {
14967 struct breakpoint *t;
14968 int tpnum;
14969 const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
14970
14971 if (parser != NULL)
14972 {
14973 gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
14974 tpnum = parser->get_number ();
14975 }
14976 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
14977 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
14978 else
14979 tpnum = get_number (arg);
14980
14981 if (tpnum <= 0)
14982 {
14983 if (instring && *instring)
14984 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
14985 instring);
14986 else
14987 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
14988 return NULL;
14989 }
14990
14991 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
14992 if (t->number == tpnum)
14993 {
14994 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14995 }
14996
14997 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
14998 return NULL;
14999 }
15000
15001 void
15002 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
15003 {
15004 if (b->thread != -1)
15005 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
15006
15007 if (b->task != 0)
15008 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
15009
15010 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
15011 }
15012
15013 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
15014 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
15015 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
15016 non-zero. */
15017
15018 static void
15019 save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty,
15020 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15021 {
15022 struct breakpoint *tp;
15023 int any = 0;
15024 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15025
15026 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15027 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15028
15029 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15030 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15031 {
15032 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15033 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15034 continue;
15035
15036 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15037 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15038 continue;
15039
15040 any = 1;
15041
15042 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15043 {
15044 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15045
15046 /* We can stop searching. */
15047 break;
15048 }
15049 }
15050
15051 if (!any)
15052 {
15053 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15054 return;
15055 }
15056
15057 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename));
15058
15059 stdio_file fp;
15060
15061 if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w"))
15062 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15063 expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno));
15064
15065 if (extra_trace_bits)
15066 save_trace_state_variables (&fp);
15067
15068 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15069 {
15070 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15071 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15072 continue;
15073
15074 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15075 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15076 continue;
15077
15078 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, &fp);
15079
15080 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15081 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15082 instead. */
15083
15084 if (tp->cond_string)
15085 fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15086
15087 if (tp->ignore_count)
15088 fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15089
15090 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15091 {
15092 fp.puts (" commands\n");
15093
15094 current_uiout->redirect (&fp);
15095 TRY
15096 {
15097 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands.get (), 2);
15098 }
15099 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15100 {
15101 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15102 throw_exception (ex);
15103 }
15104 END_CATCH
15105
15106 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15107 fp.puts (" end\n");
15108 }
15109
15110 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15111 fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n");
15112
15113 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15114 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15115 special, and not user visible. */
15116 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15117 {
15118 struct bp_location *loc;
15119 int n = 1;
15120
15121 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15122 if (!loc->enabled)
15123 fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15124 }
15125 }
15126
15127 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15128 fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15129
15130 if (from_tty)
15131 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ());
15132 }
15133
15134 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15135
15136 static void
15137 save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15138 {
15139 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15140 }
15141
15142 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15143
15144 static void
15145 save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15146 {
15147 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15148 }
15149
15150 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15151
15152 std::vector<breakpoint *>
15153 all_tracepoints (void)
15154 {
15155 std::vector<breakpoint *> tp_vec;
15156 struct breakpoint *tp;
15157
15158 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15159 {
15160 tp_vec.push_back (tp);
15161 }
15162
15163 return tp_vec;
15164 }
15165
15166 \f
15167 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15168 locations used by several commands. */
15169
15170 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15171 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15172 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15173 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15174 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15175 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15176 \n\
15177 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15178 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15179 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15180 \n\
15181 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15182 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15183 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15184 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15185 -function fact -label the_top\".\n\
15186 \n\
15187 By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\
15188 functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\
15189 classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\
15190 \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\
15191 \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\
15192 specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead.\n"
15193
15194 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15195 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15196 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15197 command. */
15198
15199 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15200 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15201 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15202 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15203 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15204 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15205 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15206 below.\n\
15207 \n\
15208 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15209 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15210 \n\
15211 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15212 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15213 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15214 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15215 conditions are different.\n\
15216 \n\
15217 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15218
15219 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15220 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15221
15222 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15223 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15224
15225 void
15226 add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring,
15227 cmd_const_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15228 completer_ftype *completer,
15229 void *user_data_catch,
15230 void *user_data_tcatch)
15231 {
15232 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15233
15234 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15235 &catch_cmdlist);
15236 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15237 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15238 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15239
15240 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15241 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15242 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15243 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15244 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15245 }
15246
15247 static void
15248 save_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
15249 {
15250 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
15251 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
15252 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
15253 }
15254
15255 struct breakpoint *
15256 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
15257 void *data)
15258 {
15259 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15260
15261 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15262 {
15263 if ((*callback) (b, data))
15264 return b;
15265 }
15266
15267 return NULL;
15268 }
15269
15270 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15271 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15272
15273 static int
15274 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15275 {
15276 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15277 non-inline function. */
15278 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15279 return 1;
15280
15281 return 0;
15282 }
15283
15284 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15285 have been inlined. */
15286
15287 int
15288 pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15289 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15290 {
15291 struct breakpoint *b;
15292 struct bp_location *bl;
15293
15294 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
15295 {
15296 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15297 continue;
15298
15299 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
15300 {
15301 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15302 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15303 return 1;
15304 }
15305 }
15306
15307 return 0;
15308 }
15309
15310 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15311
15312 void
15313 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15314 {
15315 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
15316
15317 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
15318 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15319 loc->symtab = NULL;
15320 }
15321
15322 void
15323 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15324 {
15325 static int initialized = 0;
15326
15327 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15328
15329 if (initialized)
15330 return;
15331 initialized = 1;
15332
15333 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15334 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15335 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15336 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15337 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15338 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15339 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
15340 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
15341 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
15342 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
15343 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
15344 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
15345
15346 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15347 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15348 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15349 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15350 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15351 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15352 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15353 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15354
15355 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15356 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
15357 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15358 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
15359 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
15360 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
15361 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
15362 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
15363 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
15364 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
15365
15366 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15367 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
15368 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15369 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
15370 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
15371 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
15372 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
15373
15374 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15375 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15376 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15377 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
15378 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
15379 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
15380 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
15381
15382 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15383 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15384 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15385 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
15386 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
15387 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15388 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
15389
15390 /* Watchpoints. */
15391 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15392 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15393 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
15394 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
15395 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
15396 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
15397 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
15398 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
15399 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
15400 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
15401 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
15402 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
15403 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
15404
15405 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15406 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15407 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15408 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
15409 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
15410 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
15411 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
15412 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
15413 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
15414 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
15415 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
15416
15417 /* Tracepoints. */
15418 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15419 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15420 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
15421 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
15422 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
15423 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
15424 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
15425 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
15426 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
15427 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
15428
15429 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15430 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15431 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15432 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15433 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
15434
15435 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15436 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15437 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15438 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
15439 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
15440 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
15441
15442 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15443 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
15444 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15445 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
15446 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
15447 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
15448 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
15449 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
15450 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
15451 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
15452
15453 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15454 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
15455 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15456 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
15457 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
15458 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
15459 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
15460 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
15461 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
15462 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
15463
15464 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15465 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
15466 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15467 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
15468 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
15469 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
15470 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
15471 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
15472 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
15473 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
15474
15475 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15476 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
15477 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15478 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
15479 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
15480 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
15481 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
15482 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
15483 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
15484 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
15485 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
15486
15487 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
15488 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15489 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
15490 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15491 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15492 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15493 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
15494 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
15495 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
15496 }
15497
15498 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
15499
15500 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
15501
15502 /* See breakpoint.h. */
15503
15504 cmd_list_element *commands_cmd_element = nullptr;
15505
15506 void
15507 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
15508 {
15509 struct cmd_list_element *c;
15510
15511 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15512
15513 gdb::observers::solib_unloaded.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
15514 gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
15515 gdb::observers::memory_changed.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
15516
15517 breakpoint_objfile_key
15518 = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_objfile_data);
15519
15520 breakpoint_chain = 0;
15521 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15522 before a breakpoint is set. */
15523 breakpoint_count = 0;
15524
15525 tracepoint_count = 0;
15526
15527 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
15528 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15529 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15530
15531 commands_cmd_element = add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint,
15532 commands_command, _("\
15533 Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\
15534 Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15535 A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\
15536 (e.g. `5-7').\n\
15537 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15538 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15539 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15540 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
15541 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
15542
15543 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
15544 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
15545 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
15546 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
15547 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
15548
15549 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
15550 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
15551 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15552 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
15553 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
15554 \n"
15555 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
15556 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15557
15558 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
15559 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15560 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
15561 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
15562 \n"
15563 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
15564 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15565
15566 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
15567 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15568 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15569 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
15570 \n"
15571 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
15572 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15573
15574 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15575 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15576 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15577 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15578 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15579 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
15580 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15581
15582 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15583
15584 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15585 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15586 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15587 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15588 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
15589 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
15590
15591 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15592 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15593 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15594 &enablebreaklist);
15595
15596 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15597 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15598 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15599 &enablebreaklist);
15600
15601 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15602 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15603 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15604 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15605 &enablebreaklist);
15606
15607 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15608 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15609 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15610 &enablelist);
15611
15612 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15613 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15614 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15615 &enablelist);
15616
15617 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15618 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15619 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15620 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15621 &enablelist);
15622
15623 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15624 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15625 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15626 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15627 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
15628 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15629 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15630 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15631
15632 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
15633 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15634 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15635 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15636 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
15637 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
15638 &disablelist);
15639
15640 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15641 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15642 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15643 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15644 \n\
15645 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
15646 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
15647 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
15648 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15649 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15650
15651 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
15652 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15653 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15654 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15655 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
15656 &deletelist);
15657
15658 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
15659 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
15660 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
15661 \n\
15662 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
15663 is executing in.\n"
15664 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15665 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
15666 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
15667
15668 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
15669 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
15670 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
15671 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15672
15673 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
15674 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
15675 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
15676 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
15677
15678 if (dbx_commands)
15679 {
15680 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
15681 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
15682 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
15683 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
15684 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
15685 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
15686 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
15687 add_com ("status", class_info, info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15688 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15689 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15690 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15691 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15692 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15693 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15694 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15695 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15696 \n\
15697 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15698 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15699 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15700 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15701 breakpoint set."));
15702 }
15703
15704 add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15705 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
15706 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15707 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15708 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15709 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15710 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15711 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15712 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15713 \n\
15714 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15715 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15716 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15717 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15718 breakpoint set."));
15719
15720 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
15721
15722 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
15723 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15724 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15725 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15726 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15727 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
15728 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
15729 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
15730 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
15731 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15732 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15733 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15734 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15735 \n\
15736 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15737 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15738 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15739 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15740 breakpoint set."),
15741 &maintenanceinfolist);
15742
15743 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
15744 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
15745 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
15746 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15747
15748 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
15749 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
15750 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
15751 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15752
15753 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
15754 catch_fork_command_1,
15755 NULL,
15756 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
15757 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
15758 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
15759 catch_fork_command_1,
15760 NULL,
15761 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
15762 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
15763 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
15764 catch_exec_command_1,
15765 NULL,
15766 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15767 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15768 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
15769 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
15770 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15771 catch_load_command_1,
15772 NULL,
15773 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15774 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15775 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
15776 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
15777 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15778 catch_unload_command_1,
15779 NULL,
15780 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15781 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15782
15783 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
15784 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15785 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15786 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15787 an expression changes.\n\
15788 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15789 the memory to which it refers."));
15790 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15791
15792 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
15793 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15794 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15795 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15796 an expression is read.\n\
15797 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15798 the memory to which it refers."));
15799 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15800
15801 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
15802 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15803 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15804 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15805 an expression is either read or written.\n\
15806 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15807 the memory to which it refers."));
15808 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15809
15810 add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\
15811 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
15812
15813 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
15814 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
15815 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
15816 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
15817 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15818 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15819 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
15820 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
15821 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
15822 hardware.)"),
15823 NULL,
15824 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
15825 &setlist, &showlist);
15826
15827 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
15828
15829 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
15830
15831 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
15832 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15833 \n"
15834 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
15835 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15836 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15837
15838 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
15839 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15840 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15841 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15842
15843 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
15844 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15845 \n"
15846 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
15847 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15848 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15849
15850 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
15851 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
15852 \n\
15853 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
15854 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
15855 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
15856 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
15857 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
15858 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
15859 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
15860 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
15861 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
15862 \n\
15863 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15864 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15865 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15866 conditions are different.\n\
15867 \n\
15868 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
15869 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15870 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15871
15872 add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\
15873 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
15874 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
15875 last tracepoint set."));
15876
15877 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
15878
15879 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
15880 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
15881 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15882 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
15883 &deletelist);
15884 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
15885
15886 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
15887 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
15888 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15889 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
15890 &disablelist);
15891 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
15892
15893 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
15894 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
15895 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15896 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
15897 &enablelist);
15898 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
15899
15900 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
15901 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
15902 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
15903 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
15904 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
15905
15906 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
15907 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
15908 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
15909 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15910
15911 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
15912 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
15913 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
15914 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
15915 session to restore them."),
15916 &save_cmdlist);
15917 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15918
15919 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
15920 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
15921 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
15922 &save_cmdlist);
15923 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15924
15925 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
15926 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
15927
15928 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
15929 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
15930 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15931 pending breakpoint behavior"),
15932 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
15933 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
15934 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
15935 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
15936 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15937 pending breakpoint behavior"),
15938 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
15939 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
15940
15941 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
15942 &pending_break_support, _("\
15943 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15944 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15945 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
15946 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
15947 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
15948 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
15949 NULL,
15950 show_pending_break_support,
15951 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15952 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15953
15954 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
15955
15956 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
15957 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
15958 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15959 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15960 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
15961 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
15962 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
15963 NULL,
15964 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
15965 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15966 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15967
15968 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
15969 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
15970 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15971 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15972 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
15973 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
15974 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
15975 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
15976 when execution stops."),
15977 NULL,
15978 &show_always_inserted_mode,
15979 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15980 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15981
15982 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
15983 condition_evaluation_enums,
15984 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
15985 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15986 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15987 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
15988 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
15989 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
15990 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
15991 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
15992 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
15993 be set to \"gdb\""),
15994 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
15995 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
15996 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15997 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15998
15999 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
16000 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
16001 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
16002 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
16003 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
16004 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
16005 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
16006 or the start of the range\n\
16007 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
16008 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
16009 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
16010 \n\
16011 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16012 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16013 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16014
16015 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16016 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
16017 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16018 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
16019 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
16020 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16021
16022 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16023 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16024 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16025 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16026 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16027 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16028 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16029 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16030 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16031 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16032 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16033 &setlist, &showlist);
16034
16035 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16036 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16037 &dprintf_function, _("\
16038 Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16039 Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16040 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16041 &setlist, &showlist);
16042
16043 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16044 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16045 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16046 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16047 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16048 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16049 &setlist, &showlist);
16050
16051 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
16052 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
16053 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16054 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16055 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
16056 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
16057 NULL,
16058 NULL,
16059 &setlist, &showlist);
16060
16061 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16062 agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\
16063 (target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16064
16065 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
16066
16067 gdb::observers::about_to_proceed.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
16068 gdb::observers::thread_exit.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints);
16069 }
This page took 0.437895 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.